PIC16F684 Data Sheet 14-Pin, Flash-Based 8-Bit CMOS Microcontrollers with nanoWatt Technology © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F Note the following details of the code protection feature on Microchip devices: • Microchip products meet the specification contained in their particular Microchip Data Sheet. • Microchip believes that its family of products is one of the most secure families of its kind on the market today, when used in the intended manner and under normal conditions. • There are dishonest and possibly illegal methods used to breach the code protection feature. All of these methods, to our knowledge, require using the Microchip products in a manner outside the operating specifications contained in Microchip’s Data Sheets. Most likely, the person doing so is engaged in theft of intellectual property. • Microchip is willing to work with the customer who is concerned about the integrity of their code. • Neither Microchip nor any other semiconductor manufacturer can guarantee the security of their code. Code protection does not mean that we are guaranteeing the product as “unbreakable.” Code protection is constantly evolving. We at Microchip are committed to continuously improving the code protection features of our products. Attempts to break Microchip’s code protection feature may be a violation of the Digital Millennium Copyright Act. If such acts allow unauthorized access to your software or other copyrighted work, you may have a right to sue for relief under that Act. Information contained in this publication regarding device applications and the like is provided only for your convenience and may be superseded by updates. It is your responsibility to ensure that your application meets with your specifications. MICROCHIP MAKES NO REPRESENTATIONS OR WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND WHETHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, WRITTEN OR ORAL, STATUTORY OR OTHERWISE, RELATED TO THE INFORMATION, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO ITS CONDITION, QUALITY, PERFORMANCE, MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR PURPOSE. Microchip disclaims all liability arising from this information and its use. Use of Microchip devices in life support and/or safety applications is entirely at the buyer’s risk, and the buyer agrees to defend, indemnify and hold harmless Microchip from any and all damages, claims, suits, or expenses resulting from such use. No licenses are conveyed, implicitly or otherwise, under any Microchip intellectual property rights. Trademarks The Microchip name and logo, the Microchip logo, Accuron, dsPIC, KEELOQ, KEELOQ logo, microID, MPLAB, PIC, PICmicro, PICSTART, PRO MATE, PowerSmart, rfPIC, and SmartShunt are registered trademarks of Microchip Technology Incorporated in the U.S.A. and other countries. AmpLab, FilterLab, Linear Active Thermistor, Migratable Memory, MXDEV, MXLAB, PS logo, SEEVAL, SmartSensor and The Embedded Control Solutions Company are registered trademarks of Microchip Technology Incorporated in the U.S.A. Analog-for-the-Digital Age, Application Maestro, CodeGuard, dsPICDEM, dsPICDEM.net, dsPICworks, ECAN, ECONOMONITOR, FanSense, FlexROM, fuzzyLAB, In-Circuit Serial Programming, ICSP, ICEPIC, Mindi, MiWi, MPASM, MPLAB Certified logo, MPLIB, MPLINK, PICkit, PICDEM, PICDEM.net, PICLAB, PICtail, PowerCal, PowerInfo, PowerMate, PowerTool, REAL ICE, rfLAB, rfPICDEM, Select Mode, Smart Serial, SmartTel, Total Endurance, UNI/O, WiperLock and ZENA are trademarks of Microchip Technology Incorporated in the U.S.A. and other countries. SQTP is a service mark of Microchip Technology Incorporated in the U.S.A. All other trademarks mentioned herein are property of their respective companies. © 2007, Microchip Technology Incorporated, Printed in the U.S.A., All Rights Reserved. Printed on recycled paper. Microchip received ISO/TS-16949:2002 certification for its worldwide headquarters, design and wafer fabrication facilities in Chandler and Tempe, Arizona, Gresham, Oregon and Mountain View, California. The Company’s quality system processes and procedures are for its PIC® MCUs and dsPIC® DSCs, KEELOQ® code hopping devices, Serial EEPROMs, microperipherals, nonvolatile memory and analog products. In addition, Microchip’s quality system for the design and manufacture of development systems is ISO 9001:2000 certified. DS41202F-page ii © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 14-Pin Flash-Based, 8-Bit CMOS Microcontrollers with nanoWatt Technology High-Performance RISC CPU: Low-Power Features: • Only 35 instructions to learn: - All single-cycle instructions except branches • Operating speed: - DC – 20 MHz oscillator/clock input - DC – 200 ns instruction cycle • Interrupt capability • 8-level deep hardware stack • Direct, Indirect and Relative Addressing modes • Standby Current: - 50 nA @ 2.0V, typical • Operating Current: - 11 μA @ 32 kHz, 2.0V, typical - 220 μA @ 4 MHz, 2.0V, typical • Watchdog Timer Current: - 1 μA @ 2.0V, typical Peripheral Features: Special Microcontroller Features: • 12 I/O pins with individual direction control: - High current source/sink for direct LED drive - Interrupt-on-change pin - Individually programmable weak pull-ups - Ultra Low-Power Wake-Up (ULPWU) • Analog Comparator module with: - Two analog comparators - Programmable on-chip voltage reference (CVREF) module (% of VDD) - Comparator inputs and outputs externally accessible • A/D Converter: - 10-bit resolution and 8 channels • Timer0: 8-bit timer/counter with 8-bit programmable prescaler • Enhanced Timer1: - 16-bit timer/counter with prescaler - External Timer1 Gate (count enable) - Option to use OSC1 and OSC2 in LP mode as Timer1 oscillator if INTOSC mode selected • Timer2: 8-bit timer/counter with 8-bit period register, prescaler and postscaler • Enhanced Capture, Compare, PWM module: - 16-bit Capture, max resolution 12.5 ns - Compare, max resolution 200 ns - 10-bit PWM with 1, 2 or 4 output channels, programmable “dead time”, max frequency 20 kHz • In-Circuit Serial ProgrammingTM (ICSPTM) via two pins • Precision Internal Oscillator: - Factory calibrated to ±1%, typical - Software selectable frequency range of 8 MHz to 125 kHz - Software tunable - Two-Speed Start-up mode - Crystal fail detect for critical applications - Clock mode switching during operation for power savings • Software Selectable 31 kHz Internal Oscillator • Power-Saving Sleep mode • Wide operating voltage range (2.0V-5.5V) • Industrial and Extended Temperature range • Power-on Reset (POR) • Power-up Timer (PWRT) and Oscillator Start-up Timer (OST) • Brown-out Reset (BOR) with software control option • Enhanced low-current Watchdog Timer (WDT) with on-chip oscillator (software selectable nominal 268 seconds with full prescaler) with software enable • Multiplexed Master Clear with pull-up/input pin • Programmable code protection • High Endurance Flash/EEPROM cell: - 100,000 write Flash endurance - 1,000,000 write EEPROM endurance - Flash/Data EEPROM retention: > 40 years Device PIC16F684 Program Memory Data Memory Flash (words) SRAM (bytes) EEPROM (bytes) 2048 128 256 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. I/O 10-bit A/D (ch) Comparators Timers 8/16-bit 12 8 2 2/1 DS41202F-page 1 PIC16F684 14-Pin Diagram (PDIP, SOIC, TSSOP) TABLE 1: 1 14 VSS 2 13 RA0/AN0/C1IN+/ICSPDAT/ULPWU RA4/AN3/T1G/OSC2/CLKOUT 3 RA3/MCLR/VPP 4 RC5/CCP1/P1A 5 RC4/C2OUT/P1B 6 RC3/AN7/P1C 7 PIC16F684 VDD RA5/T1CKI/OSC1/CLKIN 12 RA1/AN1/C1IN-/VREF/ICSPCLK 11 RA2/AN2/T0CKI/INT/C1OUT 10 RC0/AN4/C2IN+ 9 RC1/AN5/C2IN- 8 RC2/AN6/P1D DUAL IN-LINE PIN SUMMARY I/O Pin Analog Comparators Timer CCP Interrupts Pull-ups Basic RA0 13 AN0 C1IN+ — — IOC Y ICSPDAT/ULPWU RA1 12 AN1/VREF C1IN- — — IOC Y ICSPCLK RA2 11 AN2 C1OUT T0CKI — INT/IOC Y — IOC Y(2) MCLR/VPP RA3(1) 4 — — RA4 3 AN3 — T1G — IOC Y OSC2/CLKOUT RA5 2 — — T1CKI — IOC Y OSC1/CLKIN — — RC0 10 AN4 C2IN+ — — — — — RC1 9 AN5 C2IN- — — — — — RC2 8 AN6 — — P1D — — — RC3 7 AN7 — — P1C — — — RC4 6 — C2OUT — P1B — — — RC5 5 — — — CCP1/P1A — — — — 1 — — — — — — VDD — 14 — — — — — — VSS Note 1: 2: Input only. Only when pin is configured for external MCLR. DS41202F-page 2 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 TABLE 2: RA5/T1CKI/OSC1/CLKIN 1 RA4/AN3/T1G/OSC2/CLKOUT 2 VDD NC NC VSS 16 15 14 13 16-Pin Diagram (QFN) 12 RA0/AN0/C1IN+/ICSPDAT/ULPWU 11 RA1/AN1/C1IN-/VREF/ICSPCLK RA2/AN2/T0CKI/INT/C1OUT PIC16F684 7 8 RC1/AN5/C2IN- 9 RC2/AN6/P1D 4 6 RC5/CCP1/P1A RC3/AN7/P1C 10 5 3 RC4/C2OUT/P1B RA3/MCLR/VPP RC0/AN4/C2IN+ QFN PIN SUMMARY I/O Pin Analog Comparators Timers CCP Interrupts Pull-ups Basic RA0 12 AN0 C1IN+ — — IOC Y ICSPDAT/ULPWU RA1 11 AN1/VREF C1IN- — — IOC Y ICSPCLK RA2 10 AN2 C1OUT T0CKI — INT/IOC Y — IOC Y(2) MCLR/VPP RA3 (1) 3 — — — — RA4 2 AN3 — T1G — IOC Y OSC2/CLKOUT RA5 1 — — T1CKI — IOC Y OSC1/CLKIN RC0 9 AN4 C2IN+ — — — — — RC1 8 AN5 C2IN- — — — — — RC2 7 AN6 — — P1D — — — RC3 6 AN7 — — P1C — — — RC4 5 — C2OUT — P1B — — — RC5 4 — — — CCP1/P1A — — — — 16 — — — — — — VDD — 13 — — — — — — VSS Note 1: 2: Input only. Only when pin is configured for external MCLR. © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 3 PIC16F684 Table of Contents 1.0 Device Overview .......................................................................................................................................................................... 5 2.0 Memory Organization ................................................................................................................................................................... 7 3.0 Oscillator Module (With Fail-Safe Clock Monitor)....................................................................................................................... 19 4.0 I/O Ports ..................................................................................................................................................................................... 31 5.0 Timer0 Module ........................................................................................................................................................................... 43 6.0 Timer1 Module with Gate Control............................................................................................................................................... 47 7.0 Timer2 Module ........................................................................................................................................................................... 53 8.0 Comparator Module.................................................................................................................................................................... 55 9.0 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) Module ................................................................................................................................ 65 10.0 Data EEPROM Memory ............................................................................................................................................................. 75 11.0 Enhanced Capture/Compare/PWM (With Auto-Shutdown and Dead Band) Module ................................................................. 79 12.0 Special Features of the CPU ...................................................................................................................................................... 97 13.0 Instruction Set Summary .......................................................................................................................................................... 115 14.0 Development Support............................................................................................................................................................... 125 15.0 Electrical Specifications............................................................................................................................................................ 129 16.0 DC and AC Characteristics Graphs and Tables ....................................................................................................................... 151 17.0 Packaging Information.............................................................................................................................................................. 173 Appendix A: Data Sheet Revision History.......................................................................................................................................... 179 Appendix B: Migrating from other PIC® Devices ............................................................................................................................... 179 Index .................................................................................................................................................................................................. 181 The Microchip Web Site ..................................................................................................................................................................... 187 Customer Change Notification Service .............................................................................................................................................. 187 Customer Support .............................................................................................................................................................................. 187 Reader Response .............................................................................................................................................................................. 188 Product Identification System............................................................................................................................................................. 189 TO OUR VALUED CUSTOMERS It is our intention to provide our valued customers with the best documentation possible to ensure successful use of your Microchip products. To this end, we will continue to improve our publications to better suit your needs. Our publications will be refined and enhanced as new volumes and updates are introduced. If you have any questions or comments regarding this publication, please contact the Marketing Communications Department via E-mail at [email protected] or fax the Reader Response Form in the back of this data sheet to (480) 792-4150. We welcome your feedback. Most Current Data Sheet To obtain the most up-to-date version of this data sheet, please register at our Worldwide Web site at: http://www.microchip.com You can determine the version of a data sheet by examining its literature number found on the bottom outside corner of any page. The last character of the literature number is the version number, (e.g., DS30000A is version A of document DS30000). Errata An errata sheet, describing minor operational differences from the data sheet and recommended workarounds, may exist for current devices. As device/documentation issues become known to us, we will publish an errata sheet. The errata will specify the revision of silicon and revision of document to which it applies. To determine if an errata sheet exists for a particular device, please check with one of the following: • Microchip’s Worldwide Web site; http://www.microchip.com • Your local Microchip sales office (see last page) When contacting a sales office, please specify which device, revision of silicon and data sheet (include literature number) you are using. Customer Notification System Register on our web site at www.microchip.com to receive the most current information on all of our products. DS41202F-page 4 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 1.0 DEVICE OVERVIEW The PIC16F684 is covered by this data sheet. It is available in 14-pin PDIP, SOIC, TSSOP and 16-pin QFN packages. Figure 1-1 shows a block diagram of the PIC16F684 device. Table 1-1 shows the pinout description. FIGURE 1-1: PIC16F684 BLOCK DIAGRAM INT Configuration 13 Flash 2k X 14 Program Memory Program Bus PORTA RA0 RA1 RA2 RA3 RA4 RA5 RAM 128 Bytes File Registers 8-Level Stack (13-Bit) 14 8 Data Bus Program Counter RAM Addr 9 Addr MUX Instruction Reg 7 Direct Addr 8 PORTC Indirect Addr RC0 RC1 RC2 RC3 RC4 RC5 FSR Reg STATUS Reg 8 3 Power-up Timer Instruction Decode & Control OSC1/CLKIN Oscillator Start-up Timer Power-on Reset Timing Generation ALU 8 Watchdog Timer Brown-out Reset OSC2/CLKOUT MUX Internal Oscillator Block W Reg CCP1/P1A P1B P1C P1D T1G MCLR VDD VSS T1CKI Timer0 Timer1 Timer2 ECCP T0CKI Analog-To-Digital Converter 2 Analog Comparators and Reference EEDATA 256 Bytes 8 Data EEPROM EEADDR VREF AN0 AN1 AN2 AN3 AN4 AN5 AN6 AN7 C1IN- C1IN+ C1OUT C2IN- C2IN+ C2OUT © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 5 PIC16F684 TABLE 1-1: PIC16F684 PINOUT DESCRIPTION Name RA0/AN0/C1IN+/ICSPDAT/ULPWU RA1/AN1/C1IN-/VREF/ICSPCLK RA2/AN2/T0CKI/INT/C1OUT RA3/MCLR/VPP RA4/AN3/T1G/OSC2/CLKOUT RA5/T1CKI/OSC1/CLKIN RC0/AN4/C2IN+ RC1/AN5/C2IN- RC2/AN6/P1D RC3/AN7/P1C RC4/C2OUT/P1B RC5/CCP1/P1A VDD VSS Legend: Function Input Type Output Type Description RA0 TTL CMOS AN0 AN — PORTA I/O with prog. pull-up and interrupt-on-change A/D Channel 0 input C1IN+ AN — Comparator 1 non-inverting input ICSPDAT TTL CMOS ULPWU AN — RA1 TTL CMOS AN1 AN — A/D Channel 1 input C1IN- AN — Comparator 1 inverting input Serial Programming Data I/O Ultra Low-Power Wake-Up input PORTA I/O with prog. pull-up and interrupt-on-change VREF AN — External Voltage Reference for A/D ICSPCLK ST — Serial Programming Clock RA2 ST CMOS PORTA I/O with prog. pull-up and interrupt-on-change AN2 AN — A/D Channel 2 input T0CKI ST — Timer0 clock input INT ST — C1OUT — CMOS RA3 TTL — External Interrupt Comparator 1 output PORTA input with interrupt-on-change MCLR ST — Master Clear w/internal pull-up VPP HV — Programming voltage RA4 TTL CMOS AN3 AN — A/D Channel 3 input Timer1 gate (count enable) PORTA I/O with prog. pull-up and interrupt-on-change T1G ST — OSC2 — XTAL Crystal/Resonator CLKOUT — CMOS FOSC/4 output PORTA I/O with prog. pull-up and interrupt-on-change RA5 TTL CMOS T1CKI ST — OSC1 XTAL — Crystal/Resonator CLKIN ST — External clock input/RC oscillator connection RC0 TTL CMOS AN4 AN — A/D Channel 4 input Comparator 2 non-inverting input Timer1 clock PORTC I/O C2IN+ AN — RC1 TTL CMOS AN5 AN — A/D Channel 5 input Comparator 2 inverting input C2IN- AN — RC2 TTL CMOS AN6 AN — P1D — CMOS RC3 TTL CMOS AN7 AN — PORTC I/O PORTC I/O A/D Channel 6 input PWM output PORTC I/O A/D Channel 7 input P1C — CMOS RC4 TTL CMOS PWM output PORTC I/O C2OUT — CMOS Comparator 2 output P1B — CMOS PWM output RC5 TTL CMOS PORTC I/O CCP1 ST CMOS Capture input/Compare output P1A — CMOS VDD Power — Positive supply VSS Power — Ground reference PWM output AN = Analog input or output CMOS= CMOS compatible input or output ST = Schmitt Trigger input with CMOS levels TTL = TTL compatible input DS41202F-page 6 HV = High Voltage XTAL = Crystal © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 2.0 MEMORY ORGANIZATION 2.1 Program Memory Organization The PIC16F684 has a 13-bit program counter capable of addressing an 8k x 14 program memory space. Only the first 2k x 14 (0000h-07FFh) for the PIC16F684 is physically implemented. Accessing a location above these boundaries will cause a wrap around within the first 2k x 14 space. The Reset vector is at 0000h and the interrupt vector is at 0004h (see Figure 2-1). FIGURE 2-1: PROGRAM MEMORY MAP AND STACK FOR THE PIC16F684 PC<12:0> CALL, RETURN RETFIE, RETLW 2.2 Data Memory Organization The data memory (see Figure 2-2) is partitioned into two banks, which contain the General Purpose Registers (GPR) and the Special Function Registers (SFR). The Special Function Registers are located in the first 32 locations of each bank. Register locations 20h-7Fh in Bank 0 and A0h-BFh in Bank 1 are General Purpose Registers, implemented as static RAM. Register locations F0h-FFh in Bank 1 point to addresses 70h-7Fh in Bank 0. All other RAM is unimplemented and returns ‘0’ when read. The RP0 bit of the STATUS register is the bank select bit. RP0 0 → Bank 0 is selected 1 → Bank 1 is selected 13 Note: Stack Level 1 The IRP and RP1 bits of the STATUS register are reserved and should always be maintained as ‘0’s. Stack Level 2 Stack Level 8 Reset Vector 0000h Interrupt Vector 0004h 0005h On-chip Program Memory 07FFh 0800h Wraps to 0000h-07FFh 1FFFh © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 7 PIC16F684 2.2.1 GENERAL PURPOSE REGISTER FILE The register file is organized as 128 x 8 in the PIC16F684. Each register is accessed, either directly or indirectly, through the File Select Register (FSR) (see Section 2.4 “Indirect Addressing, INDF and FSR Registers”). 2.2.2 FIGURE 2-2: DATA MEMORY MAP OF THE PIC16F684 File Address File Address Indirect Addr.(1) 00h Indirect Addr.(1) 80h TMR0 01h OPTION_REG 81h PCL 02h PCL 82h STATUS 03h STATUS 83h FSR 04h FSR 84h PORTA 05h TRISA 85h SPECIAL FUNCTION REGISTERS The Special Function Registers are registers used by the CPU and peripheral functions for controlling the desired operation of the device (see Table 2-1). These registers are static RAM. 06h PORTC 86h TRISC 07h 08h The special registers can be classified into two sets: core and peripheral. The Special Function Registers associated with the “core” are described in this section. Those related to the operation of the peripheral features are described in the section of that peripheral feature. 87h 88h 09h 89h PCLATH 0Ah PCLATH 8Ah INTCON 0Bh INTCON 8Bh PIR1 0Ch PIE1 8Ch 0Dh 8Dh TMR1L 0Eh PCON 8Eh TMR1H 0Fh OSCCON 8Fh T1CON 10h OSCTUNE 90h TMR2 11h ANSEL 91h T2CON 12h PR2 92h CCPR1L 13h CCPR1H 14h CCP1CON 15h WPUA 95h PWM1CON 16h IOCA 96h ECCPAS 17h WDTCON 18h CMCON0 19h VRCON 99h CMCON1 1Ah EEDAT 9Ah 1Bh EEADR 9Bh 1Ch EECON1 9Ch 1Dh EECON2(1) 9Dh ADRESH 1Eh ADRESL 9Eh ADCON0 1Fh ADCON1 General Purpose Registers 32 Bytes 9Fh A0h 93h 94h 97h 98h 20h General Purpose Registers BFh 96 Bytes 6Fh 70 Accesses 70h-7Fh 7Fh Bank 0 F0h FFh Bank 1 Unimplemented data memory locations, read as ‘0’. Note DS41202F-page 8 1: Not a physical register. © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 TABLE 2-1: Addr Name PIC16F684 SPECIAL FUNCTION REGISTERS SUMMARY BANK 0 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Value on POR, BOR Page Bank 0 00h INDF Addressing this location uses contents of FSR to address data memory (not a physical register) xxxx xxxx 19, 104 01h TMR0 Timer0 Module’s Register xxxx xxxx 43, 104 02h PCL Program Counter’s (PC) Least Significant Byte 0000 0000 19, 104 03h STATUS 04h FSR 05h PORTA(2) 06h 07h IRP(1) RP1(1) RP0 TO PD Z DC C Indirect Data Memory Address Pointer — PORTC(2) — — RA5 RA4 RA3 RA2 RA1 RA0 Unimplemented — — RC5 RC4 RC3 RC2 RC1 RC0 0001 1xxx 13, 104 xxxx xxxx 19, 104 --x0 x000 31, 104 — — --xx 0000 40, 104 — 08h — Unimplemented — 09h — Unimplemented — — ---0 0000 19, 104 0Ah PCLATH — — — Write Buffer for upper 5 bits of Program Counter 0Bh INTCON GIE PEIE T0IE INTE RAIE T0IF INTF RAIF 0000 0000 15, 104 0Ch PIR1 EEIF ADIF CCP1IF C2IF C1IF OSFIF TMR2IF TMR1IF 0000 0000 17, 104 0Dh — Unimplemented 0Eh TMR1L Holding Register for the Least Significant Byte of the 16-bit TMR1 Register 0Fh TMR1H Holding Register for the Most Significant Byte of the 16-bit TMR1 Register 10h T1CON 11h TMR2 12h T2CON 13h CCPR1L 14h CCPR1H 15h CCP1CON P1M1 P1M0 DC1B1 DC1B0 CCP1M3 CCP1M2 CCP1M1 16h PWM1CON PRSEN PDC6 PDC5 PDC4 PDC3 PDC2 17h ECCPAS ECCPASE ECCPAS2 ECCPAS1 ECCPAS0 PSSAC1 18h WDTCON — — — WDTPS3 19h CMCON0 C2OUT C1OUT C2INV 1Ah CMCON1 — — — — — xxxx xxxx 47, 104 xxxx xxxx 47, 104 0000 0000 50, 104 0000 0000 53, 104 -000 0000 54, 104 Capture/Compare/PWM Register 1 Low Byte XXXX XXXX 80, 104 Capture/Compare/PWM Register 1 High Byte XXXX XXXX 80, 104 CCP1M0 0000 0000 79, 104 PDC1 PDC0 0000 0000 96, 104 PSSAC0 PSSBD1 PSSBD0 0000 0000 93, 104 WDTPS2 WDTPS1 WDTPS0 SWDTEN ---0 1000 111, 104 C1INV CIS CM2 CM1 CM0 0000 0000 61, 104 — — — T1GSS C2SYNC ---- --10 62, 104 T1GINV TMR1GE T1CKPS1 T1CKPS0 T1OSCEN T1SYNC TMR1CS TMR1ON TOUTPS2 TOUTPS1 TOUTPS0 TMR2ON T2CKPS1 T2CKPS0 Timer2 Module Register — TOUTPS3 1Bh — Unimplemented — — 1Ch — Unimplemented — — 1Dh — Unimplemented — — xxxx xxxx 71, 104 00-0 0000 70, 104 1Eh ADRESH 1Fh ADCON0 Legend: Note 1: 2: Most Significant 8 bits of the left shifted A/D result or 2 bits of right shifted result ADFM VCFG — CHS2 CHS1 CHS0 GO/DONE ADON – = Unimplemented locations read as ‘0’, u = unchanged, x = unknown, q = value depends on condition, shaded = unimplemented IRP and RP1 bits are reserved, always maintain these bits clear. Port pins with analog functions controlled by the ANSEL register will read ‘0’ immediately after a Reset even though the data latches are either undefined (POR) or unchanged (other Resets). © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 9 PIC16F684 TABLE 2-2: Addr PIC16F684 SPECIAL FUNCTION REGISTERS SUMMARY BANK 1 Name Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Value on POR, BOR Page Bank 1 80h INDF 81h OPTION_REG Addressing this location uses contents of FSR to address data memory (not a physical register) 82h PCL 83h STATUS FSR 85h TRISA 86h INTEDG T0CS T0SE IRP(1) RP1(1) RP0 PS2 PS1 PS0 1111 1111 14, 104 TO PD Z DC C 0001 1xxx 13, 104 0000 0000 19, 104 Indirect Data Memory Address Pointer — TRISC — xxxx xxxx 19, 104 — TRISA5 TRISA4 TRISA3 TRISA2 TRISA1 TRISA0 --11 1111 31, 104 — TRISC5 TRISC4 TRISC3 TRISC2 TRISC1 TRISC0 --11 1111 40, 104 Unimplemented — xxxx xxxx 19, 104 PSA Program Counter’s (PC) Least Significant Byte 84h 87h RAPU — — 88h — Unimplemented — — 89h — Unimplemented — — 8Ah PCLATH — — — Write Buffer for upper 5 bits of Program Counter ---0 0000 19, 104 8Bh INTCON GIE PEIE T0IE INTE RAIE T0IF INTF RAIF 0000 0000 15, 104 8Ch PIE1 EEIE ADIE CCP1IE C2IE C1IE OSFIE TMR2IE TMR1IE 0000 0000 16, 104 — POR BOR --01 --qq 18, 104 8Dh — Unimplemented — — 8Eh PCON — — ULPWUE SBOREN — 8Fh OSCCON — IRCF2 IRCF1 IRCF0 OSTS(2) HTS LTS SCS -110 x000 20, 104 90h OSCTUNE — — — TUN4 TUN3 TUN2 TUN1 TUN0 ---0 0000 24, 105 91h ANSEL ANS7 ANS6 ANS5 ANS4 ANS3 ANS2 ANS1 ANS0 1111 1111 32, 105 92h PR2 Timer2 Module Period Register 1111 1111 53, 105 93h — Unimplemented — — 94h — Unimplemented — — 95h WPUA(3) 96h IOCA — — WPUA5 WPUA4 — WPUA2 WPUA1 WPUA0 --11 -111 33, 105 — — IOCA5 IOCA4 IOCA3 IOCA2 IOCA1 IOCA0 --00 0000 33, 105 97h — Unimplemented — — 98h — Unimplemented — — 99h VRCON 9Ah EEDAT EEDAT7 EEDAT6 EEDAT5 EEDAT4 EEDAT3 EEDAT2 9Bh EEADR EEADR7 EEADR6 EEADR5 EEADR4 EEADR3 EEADR2 9Ch EECON1 — — — — WRERR WREN WR 9Dh EECON2 EEPROM Control Register 2 (not a physical register) 9Eh ADRESL Least Significant 2 bits of the left shifted result or 8 bits of the right shifted result 9Fh ADCON1 Legend: Note 1: 2: 3: VREN — — ADCS2 VRR ADCS1 — ADCS0 VR3 VR2 VR1 VR0 0-0- 0000 63, 105 EEDAT1 EEDAT0 0000 0000 75, 105 EEADR1 EEADR0 0000 0000 75, 105 RD ---- x000 76, 105 ---- ---- 76, 105 — — xxxx xxxx 71, 105 — — -000 ---- 70, 105 – = Unimplemented locations read as ‘0’, u = unchanged, x = unknown, q = value depends on condition, shaded = unimplemented IRP and RP1 bits are reserved, always maintain these bits clear. OSTS bit of the OSCCON register reset to ‘0’ with Dual Speed Start-up and LP, HS or XT selected as the oscillator. RA3 pull-up is enabled when MCLRE is ‘1’ in the Configuration Word register. DS41202F-page 10 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 2.2.2.1 STATUS Register The STATUS register, shown in Register 2-1, contains: • the arithmetic status of the ALU • the Reset status • the bank select bits for data memory (SRAM) It is recommended, therefore, that only BCF, BSF, SWAPF and MOVWF instructions are used to alter the STATUS register, because these instructions do not affect any Status bits. For other instructions not affecting any Status bits, see Section 13.0 “Instruction Set Summary”. Note 1: Bits IRP and RP1 of the STATUS register are not used by the PIC16F684 and should be maintained as clear. Use of these bits is not recommended, since this may affect upward compatibility with future products. The STATUS register can be the destination for any instruction, like any other register. If the STATUS register is the destination for an instruction that affects the Z, DC or C bits, then the write to these three bits is disabled. These bits are set or cleared according to the device logic. Furthermore, the TO and PD bits are not writable. Therefore, the result of an instruction with the STATUS register as destination may be different than intended. 2: The C and DC bits operate as a Borrow and Digit Borrow out bit, respectively, in subtraction. See the SUBLW and SUBWF instructions for examples. For example, CLRF STATUS, will clear the upper three bits and set the Z bit. This leaves the STATUS register as ‘000u u1uu’ (where u = unchanged). REGISTER 2-1: STATUS: STATUS REGISTER Reserved Reserved R/W-0 R-1 R-1 R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x IRP RP1 RP0 TO PD Z DC C bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 7 IRP: This bit is reserved and should be maintained as ‘0’ bit 6 RP1: This bit is reserved and should be maintained as ‘0’ bit 5 RP0: Register Bank Select bit (used for direct addressing) 1 = Bank 1 (80h – FFh) 0 = Bank 0 (00h – 7Fh) bit 4 TO: Time-out bit 1 = After power-up, CLRWDT instruction or SLEEP instruction 0 = A WDT time-out occurred bit 3 PD: Power-down bit 1 = After power-up or by the CLRWDT instruction 0 = By execution of the SLEEP instruction bit 2 Z: Zero bit 1 = The result of an arithmetic or logic operation is zero 0 = The result of an arithmetic or logic operation is not zero bit 1 DC: Digit Carry/Borrow bit (ADDWF, ADDLW,SUBLW,SUBWF instructions), For Borrow, the polarity is reversed. 1 = A carry-out from the 4th low-order bit of the result occurred 0 = No carry-out from the 4th low-order bit of the result bit 0 C: Carry/Borrow bit(1) (ADDWF, ADDLW, SUBLW, SUBWF instructions) 1 = A carry-out from the Most Significant bit of the result occurred 0 = No carry-out from the Most Significant bit of the result occurred Note 1: For Borrow, the polarity is reversed. A subtraction is executed by adding the two’s complement of the second operand. For rotate (RRF, RLF) instructions, this bit is loaded with either the high-order or low-order bit of the source register. © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 11 PIC16F684 2.2.2.2 OPTION Register Note: The OPTION register is a readable and writable register, which contains various control bits to configure: • • • • Timer0/WDT prescaler External RA2/INT interrupt Timer0 Weak pull-ups on PORTA REGISTER 2-2: To achieve a 1:1 prescaler assignment for Timer0, assign the prescaler to the WDT by setting PSA bit to ‘1’ of the OPTION register. See Section 5.1.3 “Software Programmable Prescaler”. OPTION_REG: OPTION REGISTER R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 RAPU INTEDG T0CS T0SE PSA PS2 PS1 PS0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 7 RAPU: PORTA Pull-up Enable bit 1 = PORTA pull-ups are disabled 0 = PORTA pull-ups are enabled by individual PORT latch values bit 6 INTEDG: Interrupt Edge Select bit 1 = Interrupt on rising edge of RA2/INT pin 0 = Interrupt on falling edge of RA2/INT pin bit 5 T0CS: Timer0 Clock Source Select bit 1 = Transition on RA2/T0CKI pin 0 = Internal instruction cycle clock (FOSC/4) bit 4 T0SE: Timer0 Source Edge Select bit 1 = Increment on high-to-low transition on RA2/T0CKI pin 0 = Increment on low-to-high transition on RA2/T0CKI pin bit 3 PSA: Prescaler Assignment bit 1 = Prescaler is assigned to the WDT 0 = Prescaler is assigned to the Timer0 module bit 2-0 PS<2:0>: Prescaler Rate Select bits BIT VALUE 000 001 010 011 100 101 110 111 DS41202F-page 12 x = Bit is unknown TIMER0 RATE WDT RATE 1:2 1:4 1:8 1 : 16 1 : 32 1 : 64 1 : 128 1 : 256 1:1 1:2 1:4 1:8 1 : 16 1 : 32 1 : 64 1 : 128 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 2.2.2.3 INTCON Register Note: The INTCON register is a readable and writable register, which contains the various enable and flag bits for TMR0 register overflow, PORTA change and external RA2/INT pin interrupts. REGISTER 2-3: Interrupt flag bits are set when an interrupt condition occurs, regardless of the state of its corresponding enable bit or the global enable bit, GIE of the INTCON register. User software should ensure the appropriate interrupt flag bits are clear prior to enabling an interrupt. INTCON: INTERRUPT CONTROL REGISTER R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 GIE PEIE T0IE INTE RAIE T0IF INTF RAIF bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 7 GIE: Global Interrupt Enable bit 1 = Enables all unmasked interrupts 0 = Disables all interrupts bit 6 PEIE: Peripheral Interrupt Enable bit 1 = Enables all unmasked peripheral interrupts 0 = Disables all peripheral interrupts bit 5 T0IE: Timer0 Overflow Interrupt Enable bit 1 = Enables the Timer0 interrupt 0 = Disables the Timer0 interrupt bit 4 INTE: RA2/INT External Interrupt Enable bit 1 = Enables the RA2/INT external interrupt 0 = Disables the RA2/INT external interrupt bit 3 RAIE: PORTA Change Interrupt Enable bit(1) 1 = Enables the PORTA change interrupt 0 = Disables the PORTA change interrupt bit 2 T0IF: Timer0 Overflow Interrupt Flag bit(2) 1 = Timer0 register has overflowed (must be cleared in software) 0 = Timer0 register did not overflow bit 1 INTF: RA2/INT External Interrupt Flag bit 1 = The RA2/INT external interrupt occurred (must be cleared in software) 0 = The RA2/INT external interrupt did not occur bit 0 RAIF: PORTA Change Interrupt Flag bit 1 = When at least one of the PORTA <5:0> pins changed state (must be cleared in software) 0 = None of the PORTA <5:0> pins have changed state Note 1: 2: IOCA register must also be enabled. T0IF bit is set when TMR0 rolls over. TMR0 is unchanged on Reset and should be initialized before clearing T0IF bit. © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 13 PIC16F684 2.2.2.4 PIE1 Register The PIE1 register contains the peripheral interrupt enable bits, as shown in Register 2-4. REGISTER 2-4: Note: Bit PEIE of the INTCON register must be set to enable any peripheral interrupt. PIE1: PERIPHERAL INTERRUPT ENABLE REGISTER 1 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 EEIE ADIE CCP1IE C2IE C1IE OSFIE TMR2IE TMR1IE bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 7 EEIE: EE Write Complete Interrupt Enable bit 1 = Enables the EE write complete interrupt 0 = Disables the EE write complete interrupt bit 6 ADIE: A/D Converter (ADC) Interrupt Enable bit 1 = Enables the ADC interrupt 0 = Disables the ADC interrupt bit 5 CCP1IE: CCP1 Interrupt Enable bit 1 = Enables the CCP1 interrupt 0 = Disables the CCP1 interrupt bit 4 C2IE: Comparator 2 Interrupt Enable bit 1 = Enables the Comparator 2 interrupt 0 = Disables the Comparator 2 interrupt bit 3 C1IE: Comparator 1 Interrupt Enable bit 1 = Enables the Comparator 1 interrupt 0 = Disables the Comparator 1 interrupt bit 2 OSFIE: Oscillator Fail Interrupt Enable bit 1 = Enables the oscillator fail interrupt 0 = Disables the oscillator fail interrupt bit 1 TMR2IE: Timer2 to PR2 Match Interrupt Enable bit 1 = Enables the Timer2 to PR2 match interrupt 0 = Disables the Timer2 to PR2 match interrupt bit 0 TMR1IE: Timer1 Overflow Interrupt Enable bit 1 = Enables the Timer1 overflow interrupt 0 = Disables the Timer1 overflow interrupt DS41202F-page 14 x = Bit is unknown © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 2.2.2.5 PIR1 Register The PIR1 register contains the peripheral interrupt flag bits, as shown in Register 2-5. REGISTER 2-5: Note: Interrupt flag bits are set when an interrupt condition occurs, regardless of the state of its corresponding enable bit or the global enable bit, GIE of the INTCON register. User software should ensure the appropriate interrupt flag bits are clear prior to enabling an interrupt. PIR1: PERIPHERAL INTERRUPT REQUEST REGISTER 1 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 EEIF ADIF CCP1IF C2IF C1IF OSFIF TMR2IF TMR1IF bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 7 EEIF: EEPROM Write Operation Interrupt Flag bit 1 = The write operation completed (must be cleared in software) 0 = The write operation has not completed or has not been started bit 6 ADIF: A/D Interrupt Flag bit 1 = A/D conversion complete 0 = A/D conversion has not completed or has not been started bit 5 CCP1IF: CCP1 Interrupt Flag bit Capture mode: 1 = A TMR1 register capture occurred (must be cleared in software) 0 = No TMR1 register capture occurred Compare mode: 1 = A TMR1 register compare match occurred (must be cleared in software) 0 = No TMR1 register compare match occurred PWM mode: Unused in this mode bit 4 C2IF: Comparator 2 Interrupt Flag bit 1 = Comparator 2 output has changed (must be cleared in software) 0 = Comparator 2 output has not changed bit 3 C1IF: Comparator 1 Interrupt Flag bit 1 = Comparator 1 output has changed (must be cleared in software) 0 = Comparator 1 output has not changed bit 2 OSFIF: Oscillator Fail Interrupt Flag bit 1 = System oscillator failed, clock input has changed to INTOSC (must be cleared in software) 0 = System clock operating bit 1 TMR2IF: Timer2 to PR2 Match Interrupt Flag bit 1 = Timer2 to PR2 match occurred (must be cleared in software) 0 = Timer2 to PR2 match has not occurred bit 0 TMR1IF: Timer1 Overflow Interrupt Flag bit 1 = Timer1 register overflowed (must be cleared in software) 0 = Timer1 has not overflowed © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 15 PIC16F684 2.2.2.6 PCON Register The Power Control (PCON) register (see Table 12-2) contains flag bits to differentiate between a: • • • • Power-on Reset (POR) Brown-out Reset (BOR) Watchdog Timer Reset (WDT) External MCLR Reset The PCON register also controls the Ultra Low-Power Wake-up and software enable of the BOR. The PCON register bits are shown in Register 2-6. REGISTER 2-6: PCON: POWER CONTROL REGISTER U-0 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-1 U-0 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-x — — ULPWUE SBOREN — — POR BOR bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 7-6 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 5 ULPWUE: Ultra Low-Power Wake-Up Enable bit 1 = Ultra Low-Power Wake-up enabled 0 = Ultra Low-Power Wake-up disabled bit 4 SBOREN: Software BOR Enable bit(1) 1 = BOR enabled 0 = BOR disabled bit 3-2 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 1 POR: Power-on Reset Status bit 1 = No Power-on Reset occurred 0 = A Power-on Reset occurred (must be set in software after a Power-on Reset occurs) bit 0 BOR: Brown-out Reset Status bit 1 = No Brown-out Reset occurred 0 = A Brown-out Reset occurred (must be set in software after a Power-on Reset or Brown-out Reset occurs) Note 1: BOREN<1:0> = 01 in the Configuration Word register for this bit to control the BOR. DS41202F-page 16 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 2.3 2.3.2 PCL and PCLATH The Program Counter (PC) is 13 bits wide. The low byte comes from the PCL register, which is a readable and writable register. The high byte (PC<12:8>) is not directly readable or writable and comes from PCLATH. On any Reset, the PC is cleared. Figure 2-3 shows the two situations for the loading of the PC. The upper example in Figure 2-3 shows how the PC is loaded on a write to PCL (PCLATH<4:0> → PCH). The lower example in Figure 2-3 shows how the PC is loaded during a CALL or GOTO instruction (PCLATH<4:3> → PCH). FIGURE 2-3: LOADING OF PC IN DIFFERENT SITUATIONS PCH PCL 12 8 7 0 PC The PIC16F684 Family has an 8-level x 13-bit wide hardware stack (see Figure 2-1). The stack space is not part of either program or data space and the Stack Pointer is not readable or writable. The PC is PUSHed onto the stack when a CALL instruction is executed or an interrupt causes a branch. The stack is POPed in the event of a RETURN, RETLW or a RETFIE instruction execution. PCLATH is not affected by a PUSH or POP operation. The stack operates as a circular buffer. This means that after the stack has been PUSHed eight times, the ninth push overwrites the value that was stored from the first push. The tenth push overwrites the second push (and so on). Note 1: There are no Status bits to indicate stack overflow or stack underflow conditions. 2: There are no instructions/mnemonics called PUSH or POP. These are actions that occur from the execution of the CALL, RETURN, RETLW and RETFIE instructions or the vectoring to an interrupt address. 8 PCLATH<4:0> 5 Instruction with PCL as Destination ALU Result PCLATH PCH 12 11 10 PCL 8 0 7 PC GOTO, CALL 2 PCLATH<4:3> 11 OPCODE <10:0> PCLATH 2.3.1 STACK MODIFYING PCL Executing any instruction with the PCL register as the destination simultaneously causes the Program Counter PC<12:8> bits (PCH) to be replaced by the contents of the PCLATH register. This allows the entire contents of the program counter to be changed by first writing the desired upper 5 bits to the PCLATH register. Then, when the lower 8 bits are written to the PCL register, all 13 bits of the program counter will change to the values contained in the PCLATH register and those being written to the PCL register. A computed GOTO is accomplished by adding an offset to the program counter (ADDWF PCL). Care should be exercised when jumping into a look-up table or program branch table (computed GOTO) by modifying the PCL register. Assuming that PCLATH is set to the table start address, if the table length is greater than 255 instructions or if the lower 8 bits of the memory address rolls over from 0xFF to 0x00 in the middle of the table, then PCLATH must be incremented for each address rollover that occurs between the table beginning and the target location within the table. 2.4 Indirect Addressing, INDF and FSR Registers The INDF register is not a physical register. Addressing the INDF register will cause indirect addressing. Indirect addressing is possible by using the INDF register. Any instruction using the INDF register actually accesses data pointed to by the File Select Register (FSR). Reading INDF itself indirectly will produce 00h. Writing to the INDF register indirectly results in a no operation (although Status bits may be affected). An effective 9-bit address is obtained by concatenating the 8-bit FSR and the IRP bit of the STATUS register, as shown in Figure 2-4. A simple program to clear RAM location 20h-2Fh using indirect addressing is shown in Example 2-1. EXAMPLE 2-1: MOVLW MOVWF NEXT CLRF INCF BTFSS GOTO CONTINUE INDIRECT ADDRESSING 0x20 FSR INDF FSR, f FSR,4 NEXT ;initialize pointer ;to RAM ;clear INDF register ;inc pointer ;all done? ;no clear next ;yes continue For more information refer to Application Note AN556, “Implementing a Table Read” (DS00556). © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 17 PIC16F684 FIGURE 2-4: DIRECT/INDIRECT ADDRESSING PIC16F684 Direct Addressing RP1 (1) RP0 6 Bank Select From Opcode Indirect Addressing IRP(1) 0 7 File Select Register Bank Select Location Select 00 01 10 0 Location Select 11 00h 180h Data Memory NOT USED 7Fh 1FFh Bank 0 Bank 1 Bank 2 Bank 3 For memory map detail, see Figure 2-2. Note 1: The RP1 and IRP bits are reserved; always maintain these bits clear. DS41202F-page 18 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 3.0 OSCILLATOR MODULE (WITH FAIL-SAFE CLOCK MONITOR) The Oscillator module can be configured in one of eight clock modes. 3.1 Overview 1. 2. 3. The Oscillator module has a wide variety of clock sources and selection features that allow it to be used in a wide range of applications while maximizing performance and minimizing power consumption. Figure 3-1 illustrates a block diagram of the Oscillator module. 4. 5. Clock sources can be configured from external oscillators, quartz crystal resonators, ceramic resonators and Resistor-Capacitor (RC) circuits. In addition, the system clock source can be configured from one of two internal oscillators, with a choice of speeds selectable via software. Additional clock features include: 6. 7. 8. • Selectable system clock source between external or internal via software. • Two-Speed Start-up mode, which minimizes latency between external oscillator start-up and code execution. • Fail-Safe Clock Monitor (FSCM) designed to detect a failure of the external clock source (LP, XT, HS, EC or RC modes) and switch automatically to the internal oscillator. FIGURE 3-1: EC – External clock with I/O on OSC2/CLKOUT. LP – 32 kHz Low-Power Crystal mode. XT – Medium Gain Crystal or Ceramic Resonator Oscillator mode. HS – High Gain Crystal or Ceramic Resonator mode. RC – External Resistor-Capacitor (RC) with FOSC/4 output on OSC2/CLKOUT. RCIO – External Resistor-Capacitor (RC) with I/O on OSC2/CLKOUT. INTOSC – Internal oscillator with FOSC/4 output on OSC2 and I/O on OSC1/CLKIN. INTOSCIO – Internal oscillator with I/O on OSC1/CLKIN and OSC2/CLKOUT. Clock Source modes are configured by the FOSC<2:0> bits in the Configuration Word register (CONFIG). The internal clock can be generated from two internal oscillators. The HFINTOSC is a calibrated high-frequency oscillator. The LFINTOSC is an uncalibrated low-frequency oscillator. PIC® MCU CLOCK SOURCE BLOCK DIAGRAM FOSC<2:0> (Configuration Word Register) SCS<0> (OSCCON Register) External Oscillator OSC2 Sleep MUX LP, XT, HS, RC, RCIO, EC OSC1 IRCF<2:0> (OSCCON Register) 8 MHz Internal Oscillator 4 MHz System Clock (CPU and Peripherals) INTOSC 111 110 101 1 MHz 100 500 kHz 250 kHz 125 kHz LFINTOSC 31 kHz 31 kHz 011 MUX HFINTOSC 8 MHz Postscaler 2 MHz 010 001 000 Power-up Timer (PWRT) Watchdog Timer (WDT) Fail-Safe Clock Monitor (FSCM) © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 19 PIC16F684 3.2 Oscillator Control The Oscillator Control (OSCCON) register (Figure 3-1) controls the system clock and frequency selection options. The OSCCON register contains the following bits: • Frequency selection bits (IRCF) • Frequency Status bits (HTS, LTS) • System clock control bits (OSTS, SCS) REGISTER 3-1: OSCCON: OSCILLATOR CONTROL REGISTER U-0 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-0 R-1 R-0 R-0 R/W-0 — IRCF2 IRCF1 IRCF0 OSTS(1) HTS LTS SCS bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 7 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 6-4 IRCF<2:0>: Internal Oscillator Frequency Select bits 111 =8 MHz 110 =4 MHz (default) 101 =2 MHz 100 =1 MHz 011 =500 kHz 010 =250 kHz 001 =125 kHz 000 =31 kHz (LFINTOSC) bit 3 OSTS: Oscillator Start-up Time-out Status bit(1) 1 = Device is running from the external clock defined by FOSC<2:0> of the CONFIG register 0 = Device is running from the internal oscillator (HFINTOSC or LFINTOSC) bit 2 HTS: HFINTOSC Status bit (High Frequency – 8 MHz to 125 kHz) 1 = HFINTOSC is stable 0 = HFINTOSC is not stable bit 1 LTS: LFINTOSC Stable bit (Low Frequency – 31 kHz) 1 = LFINTOSC is stable 0 = LFINTOSC is not stable bit 0 SCS: System Clock Select bit 1 = Internal oscillator is used for system clock 0 = Clock source defined by FOSC<2:0> of the CONFIG register Note 1: Bit resets to ‘0’ with Two-Speed Start-up and LP, XT or HS selected as the Oscillator mode or Fail-Safe mode is enabled. DS41202F-page 20 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 3.3 Clock Source Modes Clock Source modes can be classified as external or internal. • External Clock modes rely on external circuitry for the clock source. Examples are: Oscillator modules (EC mode), quartz crystal resonators or ceramic resonators (LP, XT and HS modes) and Resistor-Capacitor (RC) mode circuits. • Internal clock sources are contained internally within the Oscillator module. The Oscillator module has two internal oscillators: the 8 MHz High-Frequency Internal Oscillator (HFINTOSC) and the 31 kHz Low-Frequency Internal Oscillator (LFINTOSC). The system clock can be selected between external or internal clock sources via the System Clock Select (SCS) bit of the OSCCON register. See Section 3.6 “Clock Switching” for additional information. TABLE 3-1: 3.4 External Clock Modes 3.4.1 OSCILLATOR START-UP TIMER (OST) If the Oscillator module is configured for LP, XT or HS modes, the Oscillator Start-up Timer (OST) counts 1024 oscillations from OSC1. This occurs following a Power-on Reset (POR) and when the Power-up Timer (PWRT) has expired (if configured), or a wake-up from Sleep. During this time, the program counter does not increment and program execution is suspended. The OST ensures that the oscillator circuit, using a quartz crystal resonator or ceramic resonator, has started and is providing a stable system clock to the Oscillator module. When switching between clock sources, a delay is required to allow the new clock to stabilize. These oscillator delays are shown in Table 3-1. In order to minimize latency between external oscillator start-up and code execution, the Two-Speed Clock Start-up mode can be selected (see Section 3.7 “Two-Speed Clock Start-up Mode”). OSCILLATOR DELAY EXAMPLES Switch From Switch To Frequency Oscillator Delay Sleep/POR LFINTOSC HFINTOSC 31 kHz 125 kHz to 8 MHz Oscillator Warm-Up Delay (TWARM) Sleep/POR EC, RC DC – 20 MHz 2 cycles LFINTOSC (31 kHz) EC, RC DC – 20 MHz 1 cycle of each Sleep/POR LP, XT, HS 32 kHz to 20 MHz 1024 Clock Cycles (OST) LFINTOSC (31 kHz) HFINTOSC 125 kHz to 8 MHz 1 μs (approx.) 3.4.2 EC MODE The External Clock (EC) mode allows an externally generated logic level as the system clock source. When operating in this mode, an external clock source is connected to the OSC1 input and the OSC2 is available for general purpose I/O. Figure 3-2 shows the pin connections for EC mode. The Oscillator Start-up Timer (OST) is disabled when EC mode is selected. Therefore, there is no delay in operation after a Power-on Reset (POR) or wake-up from Sleep. Because the PIC MCU design is fully static, stopping the external clock input will have the effect of halting the device while leaving all data intact. Upon restarting the external clock, the device will resume operation as if no time had elapsed. © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. FIGURE 3-2: EXTERNAL CLOCK (EC) MODE OPERATION OSC1/CLKIN Clock from Ext. System PIC® MCU I/O Note 1: OSC2/CLKOUT(1) Alternate pin functions are listed in the Section 1.0 “Device Overview”. DS41202F-page 21 PIC16F684 3.4.3 LP, XT, HS MODES The LP, XT and HS modes support the use of quartz crystal resonators or ceramic resonators connected to OSC1 and OSC2 (Figure 3-3). The mode selects a low, medium or high gain setting of the internal inverter-amplifier to support various resonator types and speed. LP Oscillator mode selects the lowest gain setting of the internal inverter-amplifier. LP mode current consumption is the least of the three modes. This mode is designed to drive only 32.768 kHz tuning-fork type crystals (watch crystals). Note 1: Quartz crystal characteristics vary according to type, package and manufacturer. The user should consult the manufacturer data sheets for specifications and recommended application. 2: Always verify oscillator performance over the VDD and temperature range that is expected for the application. 3: For oscillator design assistance, reference the following Microchip Applications Notes: • AN826, “Crystal Oscillator Basics and Crystal Selection for rfPIC® and PIC® Devices” (DS00826) • AN849, “Basic PIC® Oscillator Design” (DS00849) • AN943, “Practical PIC® Oscillator Analysis and Design” (DS00943) • AN949, “Making Your Oscillator Work” (DS00949) XT Oscillator mode selects the intermediate gain setting of the internal inverter-amplifier. XT mode current consumption is the medium of the three modes. This mode is best suited to drive resonators with a medium drive level specification. HS Oscillator mode selects the highest gain setting of the internal inverter-amplifier. HS mode current consumption is the highest of the three modes. This mode is best suited for resonators that require a high drive setting. Figure 3-3 and Figure 3-4 show typical circuits for quartz crystal and ceramic resonators, respectively. FIGURE 3-3: FIGURE 3-4: QUARTZ CRYSTAL OPERATION (LP, XT OR HS MODE) PIC® MCU OSC1/CLKIN C1 PIC® MCU OSC1/CLKIN C1 To Internal Logic RP(3) RF(2) Sleep To Internal Logic Quartz Crystal C2 CERAMIC RESONATOR OPERATION (XT OR HS MODE) RS(1) RF(2) Sleep OSC2/CLKOUT Note 1: A series resistor (RS) may be required for quartz crystals with low drive level. 2: The value of RF varies with the Oscillator mode selected (typically between 2 MΩ to 10 MΩ). DS41202F-page 22 C2 Ceramic RS(1) Resonator Note 1: OSC2/CLKOUT A series resistor (RS) may be required for ceramic resonators with low drive level. 2: The value of RF varies with the Oscillator mode selected (typically between 2 MΩ to 10 MΩ). 3: An additional parallel feedback resistor (RP) may be required for proper ceramic resonator operation. © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 3.4.4 EXTERNAL RC MODES 3.5 The external Resistor-Capacitor (RC) modes support the use of an external RC circuit. This allows the designer maximum flexibility in frequency choice while keeping costs to a minimum when clock accuracy is not required. There are two modes: RC and RCIO. In RC mode, the RC circuit connects to OSC1. OSC2/CLKOUT outputs the RC oscillator frequency divided by 4. This signal may be used to provide a clock for external circuitry, synchronization, calibration, test or other application requirements. Figure 3-5 shows the external RC mode connections. FIGURE 3-5: VDD EXTERNAL RC MODES PIC® MCU REXT OSC1/CLKIN Internal Clock CEXT Internal Clock Modes The Oscillator module has two independent, internal oscillators that can be configured or selected as the system clock source. 1. 2. The HFINTOSC (High-Frequency Internal Oscillator) is factory calibrated and operates at 8 MHz. The frequency of the HFINTOSC can be user-adjusted via software using the OSCTUNE register (Register 3-2). The LFINTOSC (Low-Frequency Internal Oscillator) is uncalibrated and operates at 31 kHz. The system clock speed can be selected via software using the Internal Oscillator Frequency Select bits IRCF<2:0> of the OSCCON register. The system clock can be selected between external or internal clock sources via the System Clock Selection (SCS) bit of the OSCCON register. See Section 3.6 “Clock Switching” for more information. 3.5.1 VSS FOSC/4 or I/O(2) OSC2/CLKOUT (1) Recommended values: 10 kΩ ≤ REXT ≤ 100 kΩ, <3V 3 kΩ ≤ REXT ≤ 100 kΩ, 3-5V CEXT > 20 pF, 2-5V Note 1: 2: Alternate pin functions are listed in Section 1.0 “Device Overview”. Output depends upon RC or RCIO Clock mode. In RCIO mode, the RC circuit is connected to OSC1. OSC2 becomes an additional general purpose I/O pin. The RC oscillator frequency is a function of the supply voltage, the resistor (REXT) and capacitor (CEXT) values and the operating temperature. Other factors affecting the oscillator frequency are: • threshold voltage variation • component tolerances • packaging variations in capacitance The user also needs to take into account variation due to tolerance of external RC components used. INTOSC AND INTOSCIO MODES The INTOSC and INTOSCIO modes configure the internal oscillators as the system clock source when the device is programmed using the oscillator selection or the FOSC<2:0> bits in the Configuration Word register (CONFIG). In INTOSC mode, OSC1/CLKIN is available for general purpose I/O. OSC2/CLKOUT outputs the selected internal oscillator frequency divided by 4. The CLKOUT signal may be used to provide a clock for external circuitry, synchronization, calibration, test or other application requirements. In INTOSCIO mode, OSC1/CLKIN and OSC2/CLKOUT are available for general purpose I/O. 3.5.2 HFINTOSC The High-Frequency Internal Oscillator (HFINTOSC) is a factory calibrated 8 MHz internal clock source. The frequency of the HFINTOSC can be altered via software using the OSCTUNE register (Register 3-2). The output of the HFINTOSC connects to a postscaler and multiplexer (see Figure 3-1). One of seven frequencies can be selected via software using the IRCF<2:0> bits of the OSCCON register. See Section 3.5.4 “Frequency Select Bits (IRCF)” for more information. The HFINTOSC is enabled by selecting any frequency between 8 MHz and 125 kHz by setting the IRCF<2:0> bits of the OSCCON register ≠ 000. Then, set the System Clock Source (SCS) bit of the OSCCON register to ‘1’ or enable Two-Speed Start-up by setting the IESO bit in the Configuration Word register (CONFIG) to ‘1’. The HF Internal Oscillator (HTS) bit of the OSCCON register indicates whether the HFINTOSC is stable or not. © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 23 PIC16F684 3.5.2.1 OSCTUNE Register The HFINTOSC is factory calibrated but can be adjusted in software by writing to the OSCTUNE register (Register 3-2). The default value of the OSCTUNE register is ‘0’. The value is a 5-bit two’s complement number. REGISTER 3-2: When the OSCTUNE register is modified, the HFINTOSC frequency will begin shifting to the new frequency. Code execution continues during this shift. There is no indication that the shift has occurred. OSCTUNE does not affect the LFINTOSC frequency. Operation of features that depend on the LFINTOSC clock source frequency, such as the Power-up Timer (PWRT), Watchdog Timer (WDT), Fail-Safe Clock Monitor (FSCM) and peripherals, are not affected by the change in frequency. OSCTUNE: OSCILLATOR TUNING REGISTER U-0 U-0 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — — — TUN4 TUN3 TUN2 TUN1 TUN0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 7-5 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 4-0 TUN<4:0>: Frequency Tuning bits 01111 = Maximum frequency 01110 = • • • 00001 = 00000 = Oscillator module is running at the calibrated frequency. 11111 = • • • 10000 = Minimum frequency DS41202F-page 24 x = Bit is unknown © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 3.5.3 LFINTOSC The Low-Frequency Internal Oscillator (LFINTOSC) is an uncalibrated 31 kHz internal clock source. The output of the LFINTOSC connects to a postscaler and multiplexer (see Figure 3-1). Select 31 kHz, via software, using the IRCF<2:0> bits of the OSCCON register. See Section 3.5.4 “Frequency Select Bits (IRCF)” for more information. The LFINTOSC is also the frequency for the Power-up Timer (PWRT), Watchdog Timer (WDT) and Fail-Safe Clock Monitor (FSCM). The LFINTOSC is enabled by selecting 31 kHz (IRCF<2:0> bits of the OSCCON register = 000) as the system clock source (SCS bit of the OSCCON register = 1), or when any of the following are enabled: • Two-Speed Start-up IESO bit of the Configuration Word register = 1 and IRCF<2:0> bits of the OSCCON register = 000 • Power-up Timer (PWRT) • Watchdog Timer (WDT) • Fail-Safe Clock Monitor (FSCM) The LF Internal Oscillator (LTS) bit of the OSCCON register indicates whether the LFINTOSC is stable or not. 3.5.4 FREQUENCY SELECT BITS (IRCF) The output of the 8 MHz HFINTOSC and 31 kHz LFINTOSC connects to a postscaler and multiplexer (see Figure 3-1). The Internal Oscillator Frequency Select bits IRCF<2:0> of the OSCCON register select the frequency output of the internal oscillators. One of eight frequencies can be selected via software: • • • • • • • • 8 MHz 4 MHz (Default after Reset) 2 MHz 1 MHz 500 kHz 250 kHz 125 kHz 31 kHz (LFINTOSC) Note: 3.5.5 HFINTOSC AND LFINTOSC CLOCK SWITCH TIMING When switching between the LFINTOSC and the HFINTOSC, the new oscillator may already be shut down to save power (see Figure 3-6). If this is the case, there is a delay after the IRCF<2:0> bits of the OSCCON register are modified before the frequency selection takes place. The LTS and HTS bits of the OSCCON register will reflect the current active status of the LFINTOSC and HFINTOSC oscillators. The timing of a frequency selection is as follows: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. IRCF<2:0> bits of the OSCCON register are modified. If the new clock is shut down, a clock start-up delay is started. Clock switch circuitry waits for a falling edge of the current clock. CLKOUT is held low and the clock switch circuitry waits for a rising edge in the new clock. CLKOUT is now connected with the new clock. LTS and HTS bits of the OSCCON register are updated as required. Clock switch is complete. See Figure 3-1 for more details. If the internal oscillator speed selected is between 8 MHz and 125 kHz, there is no start-up delay before the new frequency is selected. This is because the old and new frequencies are derived from the HFINTOSC via the postscaler and multiplexer. Start-up delay specifications are located in the oscillator tables of Section 15.0 “Electrical Specifications”. Following any Reset, the IRCF<2:0> bits of the OSCCON register are set to ‘110’ and the frequency selection is set to 4 MHz. The user can modify the IRCF bits to select a different frequency. © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 25 PIC16F684 FIGURE 3-6: HFINTOSC INTERNAL OSCILLATOR SWITCH TIMING LFINTOSC (FSCM and WDT disabled) HFINTOSC Start-up Time 2-cycle Sync Running LFINTOSC IRCF <2:0> ≠0 =0 System Clock HFINTOSC LFINTOSC (Either FSCM or WDT enabled) HFINTOSC 2-cycle Sync Running LFINTOSC ≠0 IRCF <2:0> =0 System Clock LFINTOSC HFINTOSC LFINTOSC turns off unless WDT or FSCM is enabled LFINTOSC Start-up Time 2-cycle Sync Running HFINTOSC IRCF <2:0> = 0 ¼0 System Clock DS41202F-page 26 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 3.6 Clock Switching The system clock source can be switched between external and internal clock sources via software using the System Clock Select (SCS) bit of the OSCCON register. 3.6.1 SYSTEM CLOCK SELECT (SCS) BIT The System Clock Select (SCS) bit of the OSCCON register selects the system clock source that is used for the CPU and peripherals. • When the SCS bit of the OSCCON register = 0, the system clock source is determined by configuration of the FOSC<2:0> bits in the Configuration Word register (CONFIG). • When the SCS bit of the OSCCON register = 1, the system clock source is chosen by the internal oscillator frequency selected by the IRCF<2:0> bits of the OSCCON register. After a Reset, the SCS bit of the OSCCON register is always cleared. Note: 3.6.2 Any automatic clock switch, which may occur from Two-Speed Start-up or Fail-Safe Clock Monitor, does not update the SCS bit of the OSCCON register. The user can monitor the OSTS bit of the OSCCON register to determine the current system clock source. OSCILLATOR START-UP TIME-OUT STATUS (OSTS) BIT The Oscillator Start-up Time-out Status (OSTS) bit of the OSCCON register indicates whether the system clock is running from the external clock source, as defined by the FOSC<2:0> bits in the Configuration Word register (CONFIG), or from the internal clock source. In particular, OSTS indicates that the Oscillator Start-up Timer (OST) has timed out for LP, XT or HS modes. 3.7 Two-Speed Clock Start-up Mode Two-Speed Start-up mode provides additional power savings by minimizing the latency between external oscillator start-up and code execution. In applications that make heavy use of the Sleep mode, Two-Speed Start-up will remove the external oscillator start-up time from the time spent awake and can reduce the overall power consumption of the device. When the Oscillator module is configured for LP, XT or HS modes, the Oscillator Start-up Timer (OST) is enabled (see Section 3.4.1 “Oscillator Start-up Timer (OST)”). The OST will suspend program execution until 1024 oscillations are counted. Two-Speed Start-up mode minimizes the delay in code execution by operating from the internal oscillator as the OST is counting. When the OST count reaches 1024 and the OSTS bit of the OSCCON register is set, program execution switches to the external oscillator. 3.7.1 TWO-SPEED START-UP MODE CONFIGURATION Two-Speed Start-up mode is configured by the following settings: • IESO (of the Configuration Word register) = 1; Internal/External Switchover bit (Two-Speed Start-up mode enabled). • SCS (of the OSCCON register) = 0. • FOSC<2:0> bits in the Configuration Word register (CONFIG) configured for LP, XT or HS mode. Two-Speed Start-up mode is entered after: • Power-on Reset (POR) and, if enabled, after Power-up Timer (PWRT) has expired, or • Wake-up from Sleep. If the external clock oscillator is configured to be anything other than LP, XT or HS mode, then Two-Speed Start-up is disabled. This is because the external clock oscillator does not require any stabilization time after POR or an exit from Sleep. 3.7.2 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. TWO-SPEED START-UP SEQUENCE Wake-up from Power-on Reset or Sleep. Instructions begin execution by the internal oscillator at the frequency set in the IRCF<2:0> bits of the OSCCON register. OST enabled to count 1024 clock cycles. OST timed out, wait for falling edge of the internal oscillator. OSTS is set. System clock held low until the next falling edge of new clock (LP, XT or HS mode). System clock is switched to external clock source. This mode allows the application to wake-up from Sleep, perform a few instructions using the INTOSC as the clock source and go back to Sleep without waiting for the primary oscillator to become stable. Note: Executing a SLEEP instruction will abort the oscillator start-up time and will cause the OSTS bit of the OSCCON register to remain clear. © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 27 PIC16F684 3.7.3 CHECKING TWO-SPEED CLOCK STATUS Checking the state of the OSTS bit of the OSCCON register will confirm if the microcontroller is running from the external clock source, as defined by the FOSC<2:0> bits in the Configuration Word register (CONFIG), or the internal oscillator. FIGURE 3-7: TWO-SPEED START-UP HFINTOSC TOST OSC1 0 1 1022 1023 OSC2 Program Counter PC - N PC PC + 1 System Clock DS41202F-page 28 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 3.8 3.8.3 Fail-Safe Clock Monitor The Fail-Safe Clock Monitor (FSCM) allows the device to continue operating should the external oscillator fail. The FSCM can detect oscillator failure any time after the Oscillator Start-up Timer (OST) has expired. The FSCM is enabled by setting the FCMEN bit in the Configuration Word register (CONFIG). The FSCM is applicable to all external oscillator modes (LP, XT, HS, EC, RC and RCIO). FIGURE 3-8: FSCM BLOCK DIAGRAM Clock Monitor Latch External Clock LFINTOSC Oscillator ÷ 64 31 kHz (~32 μs) 488 Hz (~2 ms) S Q R Q The Fail-Safe condition is cleared after a Reset, executing a SLEEP instruction or toggling the SCS bit of the OSCCON register. When the SCS bit is toggled, the OST is restarted. While the OST is running, the device continues to operate from the INTOSC selected in OSCCON. When the OST times out, the Fail-Safe condition is cleared and the device will be operating from the external clock source. The Fail-Safe condition must be cleared before the OSFIF flag can be cleared. 3.8.4 3.8.1 Clock Failure Detected FAIL-SAFE DETECTION The FSCM module detects a failed oscillator by comparing the external oscillator to the FSCM sample clock. The sample clock is generated by dividing the LFINTOSC by 64. See Figure 3-8. Inside the fail detector block is a latch. The external clock sets the latch on each falling edge of the external clock. The sample clock clears the latch on each rising edge of the sample clock. A failure is detected when an entire half-cycle of the sample clock elapses before the primary clock goes low. 3.8.2 RESET OR WAKE-UP FROM SLEEP The FSCM is designed to detect an oscillator failure after the Oscillator Start-up Timer (OST) has expired. The OST is used after waking up from Sleep and after any type of Reset. The OST is not used with the EC or RC Clock modes so that the FSCM will be active as soon as the Reset or wake-up has completed. When the FSCM is enabled, the Two-Speed Start-up is also enabled. Therefore, the device will always be executing code while the OST is operating. Note: Sample Clock FAIL-SAFE CONDITION CLEARING Due to the wide range of oscillator start-up times, the Fail-Safe circuit is not active during oscillator start-up (i.e., after exiting Reset or Sleep). After an appropriate amount of time, the user should check the OSTS bit of the OSCCON register to verify the oscillator start-up and that the system clock switchover has successfully completed. FAIL-SAFE OPERATION When the external clock fails, the FSCM switches the device clock to an internal clock source and sets the bit flag OSFIF of the PIR1 register. Setting this flag will generate an interrupt if the OSFIE bit of the PIE1 register is also set. The device firmware can then take steps to mitigate the problems that may arise from a failed clock. The system clock will continue to be sourced from the internal clock source until the device firmware successfully restarts the external oscillator and switches back to external operation. The internal clock source chosen by the FSCM is determined by the IRCF<2:0> bits of the OSCCON register. This allows the internal oscillator to be configured before a failure occurs. © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 29 PIC16F684 FIGURE 3-9: FSCM TIMING DIAGRAM Sample Clock Oscillator Failure System Clock Output Clock Monitor Output (Q) Failure Detected OSCFIF Test Note: Test The system clock is normally at a much higher frequency than the sample clock. The relative frequencies in this example have been chosen for clarity. TABLE 3-2: Name Test SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH CLOCK SOURCES Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Value on: POR, BOR Value on all other Resets(1) CONFIG(2) CPD CP MCLRE PWRTE WDTE FOSC2 FOSC1 FOSC0 — — OSCCON — IRCF2 IRCF1 IRCF0 OSTS HTS LTS SCS -110 x000 -110 x000 ---u uuuu OSCTUNE — — — TUN4 TUN3 TUN2 TUN1 TUN0 ---0 0000 PIE1 EEIE ADIE CCP1IE C2IE C1IE OSFIE TMR2IE TMR1IE 0000 0000 0000 0000 PIR1 EEIF ADIF CCP1IF C2IF C1IF OSFIF TMR2IF TMR1IF 0000 0000 0000 0000 Legend: Note 1: 2: x = unknown, u = unchanged, – = unimplemented locations read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used by oscillators. Other (non Power-up) Resets include MCLR Reset and Watchdog Timer Reset during normal operation. See Configuration Word register (Register 12-1) for operation of all register bits. DS41202F-page 30 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 4.0 I/O PORTS port pins are read, this value is modified and then written to the PORT data latch. RA3 reads ‘0’ when MCLRE = 1. There are as many as twelve general purpose I/O pins available. Depending on which peripherals are enabled, some or all of the pins may not be available as general purpose I/O. In general, when a peripheral is enabled, the associated pin may not be used as a general purpose I/O pin. 4.1 The TRISA register controls the direction of the PORTA pins, even when they are being used as analog inputs. The user must ensure the bits in the TRISA register are maintained set when using them as analog inputs. I/O pins configured as analog input always read ‘0’. PORTA and the TRISA Registers Note: PORTA is a 6-bit wide, bidirectional port. The corresponding data direction register is TRISA (Register 4-2). Setting a TRISA bit (= 1) will make the corresponding PORTA pin an input (i.e., disable the output driver). Clearing a TRISA bit (= 0) will make the corresponding PORTA pin an output (i.e., enables output driver and puts the contents of the output latch on the selected pin). The exception is RA3, which is input only and its TRIS bit will always read as ‘1’. Example 4-1 shows how to initialize PORTA. EXAMPLE 4-1: Reading the PORTA register (Register 4-1) reads the status of the pins, whereas writing to it will write to the PORT latch. All write operations are read-modify-write operations. Therefore, a write to a port implies that the REGISTER 4-1: The ANSEL and CMCON0 registers must be initialized to configure an analog channel as a digital input. Pins configured as analog inputs will read ‘0’. BCF CLRF MOVLW MOVWF BSF CLRF MOVLW MOVWF STATUS,RP0 PORTA 07h CMCON0 STATUS,RP0 ANSEL 0Ch TRISA BCF STATUS,RP0 INITIALIZING PORTA ;Bank 0 ;Init PORTA ;Set RA<2:0> to ;digital I/O ;Bank 1 ;digital I/O ;Set RA<3:2> as inputs ;and set RA<5:4,1:0> ;as outputs ;Bank 0 PORTA: PORTA REGISTER U-0 U-0 R/W-x R/W-0 R-x R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — — RA5 RA4 RA3 RA2 RA1 RA0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 7-6 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 5-0 RA<5:0>: PORTA I/O Pin bit 1 = PORTA pin is > VIH 0 = PORTA pin is < VIL REGISTER 4-2: x = Bit is unknown TRISA: PORTA TRI-STATE REGISTER U-0 U-0 R/W-1 R/W-1 R-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 — — TRISA5 TRISA4 TRISA3 TRISA2 TRISA1 TRISA0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 7-6 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 5-0 TRISA<5:0>: PORTA Tri-State Control bit 1 = PORTA pin configured as an input (tri-stated) 0 = PORTA pin configured as an output Note 1: 2: x = Bit is unknown TRISA<3> always reads ‘1’. TRISA<5:4> always reads ‘1’ in XT, HS and LP OSC modes. © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 31 PIC16F684 4.2 4.2.3 Additional Pin Functions INTERRUPT-ON-CHANGE Every PORTA pin on the PIC16F684 has an interrupt-on-change option and a weak pull-up option. RA0 has an Ultra Low-Power Wake-up option. The next three sections describe these functions. Each of the PORTA pins is individually configurable as an interrupt-on-change pin. Control bits IOCAx enable or disable the interrupt function for each pin. Refer to Register 4-5. The interrupt-on-change is disabled on a Power-on Reset. 4.2.1 For enabled interrupt-on-change pins, the values are compared with the old value latched on the last read of PORTA. The ‘mismatch’ outputs of the last read are OR’d together to set the PORTA Change Interrupt Flag bit (RAIF) in the INTCON register (Register 2-3). ANSEL REGISTER The ANSEL register is used to configure the Input mode of an I/O pin to analog. Setting the appropriate ANSEL bit high will cause all digital reads on the pin to be read as ‘0’ and allow analog functions on the pin to operate correctly. The state of the ANSEL bits has no affect on digital output functions. A pin with TRIS clear and ANSEL set will still operate as a digital output, but the Input mode will be analog. This can cause unexpected behavior when executing read-modify-write instructions on the affected port. 4.2.2 WEAK PULL-UPS Each of the PORTA pins, except RA3, has an individually configurable internal weak pull-up. Control bits WPUAx enable or disable each pull-up. Refer to Register 4-4. Each weak pull-up is automatically turned off when the port pin is configured as an output. The pull-ups are disabled on a Power-on Reset by the RAPU bit of the OPTION register). A weak pull-up is automatically enabled for RA3 when configured as MCLR and disabled when RA3 is an I/O. There is no software control of the MCLR pull-up. REGISTER 4-3: This interrupt can wake the device from Sleep. The user, in the Interrupt Service Routine, clears the interrupt by: a) Any read or write of PORTA. This will end the mismatch condition, then, Clear the flag bit RAIF. b) A mismatch condition will continue to set flag bit RAIF. Reading PORTA will end the mismatch condition and allow flag bit RAIF to be cleared. The latch holding the last read value is not affected by a MCLR nor Brown-out Reset. After these resets, the RAIF flag will continue to be set if a mismatch is present. Note: If a change on the I/O pin should occur when any PORTA operation is being executed, then the RAIF interrupt flag may not get set. ANSEL: ANALOG SELECT REGISTER R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 ANS7 ANS6 ANS5 ANS4 ANS3 ANS2 ANS1 ANS0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 7-0 Note 1: x = Bit is unknown ANS<7:0>: Analog Select bits Analog select between analog or digital function on pins AN<7:0>, respectively. 1 = Analog input. Pin is assigned as analog input(1). 0 = Digital I/O. Pin is assigned to port or special function. Setting a pin to an analog input automatically disables the digital input circuitry, weak pull-ups and interrupt-on-change, if available. The corresponding TRIS bit must be set to Input mode in order to allow external control of the voltage on the pin. DS41202F-page 32 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 REGISTER 4-4: WPUA: WEAK PULL-UP PORTA REGISTER U-0 U-0 R/W-1 R/W-1 U-0 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 — — WPUA5 WPUA4 — WPUA2 WPUA1 WPUA0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 7-6 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 5-4 WPUA<5:4>: Weak Pull-up Control bits 1 = Pull-up enabled 0 = Pull-up disabled bit 3 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 2-0 WPUA<2:0>: Weak Pull-up Control bits 1 = Pull-up enabled 0 = Pull-up disabled Note 1: 2: 3: 4: x = Bit is unknown Global RAPU must be enabled for individual pull-ups to be enabled. The weak pull-up device is automatically disabled if the pin is in Output mode (TRISA = 0). The RA3 pull-up is enabled when configured as MCLR and disabled as an I/O in the Configuration Word. WPUA<5:4> always reads ‘1’ in XT, HS and LP OSC modes. REGISTER 4-5: IOCA: INTERRUPT-ON-CHANGE PORTA REGISTER U-0 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — — IOCA5 IOCA4 IOCA3 IOCA2 IOCA1 IOCA0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 7-6 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 5-0 IOCA<5:0>: Interrupt-on-change PORTA Control bit 1 = Interrupt-on-change enabled 0 = Interrupt-on-change disabled Note 1: 2: x = Bit is unknown Global Interrupt Enable (GIE) must be enabled for individual interrupts to be recognized. IOCA<5:4> always reads ‘1’ in XT, HS and LP OSC modes. © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 33 PIC16F684 4.2.4 ULTRA LOW-POWER WAKE-UP The Ultra Low-Power Wake-Up (ULPWU) on RA0 allows a slow falling voltage to generate an interrupt-on-change on RA0 without excess current consumption. The mode is selected by setting the ULPWUE bit of the PCON register. This enables a small current sink which can be used to discharge a capacitor on RA0. To use this feature, the RA0 pin is first configured to output ‘1’ to charge the capacitor. Then interrupt-on-change for RA0 is enabled, and RA0 is configured as an input. The ULPWUE bit is set to begin the discharge and a SLEEP instruction is performed. When the voltage on RA0 drops below VIL, the device will wake-up and execute the next instruction. If the GIE bit of the INTCON register is set, the device will call the interrupt service routine (0004h). See Section 4.2.3 “Interrupt-on-Change” and Section 12.4.3 “PORTA Interrupt-on-Change” for more information. This feature provides a low-power technique for periodically waking up the device from Sleep. The time-out is dependent on the discharge time of the RC circuit on RA0. See Example 4-2 for initializing the Ultra Low-Power Wake-Up module. Note: For more information, refer to AN879, “Using the Microchip Ultra Low-Power Wake-Up Module” Application Note (DS00879). EXAMPLE 4-2: BANKSEL MOVLW MOVWF BANKSEL BCF BCF BANKSEL BSF CALL BANKSEL BSF BSF BSF MOVLW MOVWF SLEEP ULTRA LOW-POWER WAKE-UP INITIALIZATION CMCON0 H’7’ CMCON0 ANSEL ANSEL,0 TRISA,0 PORTA PORTA,0 CapDelay PCON PCON,ULPWUE IOCA,0 TRISA,0 B’10001000’ INTCON ; ;Turn off ;comparators ; ;RA0 to digital I/O ;Output high to ; ;charge capacitor ; ; ;Enable ULP Wake-up ;Select RA0 IOC ;RA0 to input ;Enable interrupt ; and clear flag ;Wait for IOC The series resistor provides overcurrent protection for the RA0 pin and can allow for software calibration of the time-out (see Figure 4-1). A timer can be used to measure the charge time and discharge time of the capacitor. The charge time can then be adjusted to provide the desired interrupt delay. This technique will compensate for the affects of temperature, voltage and component accuracy. The Ultra Low-Power Wake-Up peripheral can also be configured as a simple Programmable Low Voltage Detect or temperature sensor. DS41202F-page 34 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 4.2.5 PIN DESCRIPTIONS AND DIAGRAMS 4.2.5.2 Figure 4-2 shows the diagram for this pin. The RA1 pin is configurable to function as one of the following: Each PORTA pin is multiplexed with other functions. The pins and their combined functions are briefly described here. For specific information about individual functions such as the Comparator or the ADC, refer to the appropriate section in this data sheet. 4.2.5.1 RA1/AN1/C1IN-/VREF/ICSPCLK • • • • • RA0/AN0/C1IN+/ICSPDAT/ULPWU a general purpose I/O an analog input for the ADC an analog inverting input to the comparator a voltage reference input for the ADC In-Circuit Serial Programming clock Figure 4-1 shows the diagram for this pin. The RA0 pin is configurable to function as one of the following: • • • • • a general purpose I/O an analog input for the ADC an analog non-inverting input to the comparator In-Circuit Serial Programming data an analog input for the Ultra Low-Power Wake-Up FIGURE 4-1: BLOCK DIAGRAM OF RA0 Analog(1) Input Mode VDD Data Bus D Q Weak CK Q WR WPUA RAPU VDD RD WPUA D WR PORTA Q I/O Pin CK Q VSS + D WR TRISA VT Q CK Q IULP 0 RD TRISA 1 Analog(1) Input Mode VSS ULPWUE RD PORTA D WR IOCA Q Q CK Q D EN RD IOCA Q Q3 D EN Interrupt-onChange RD PORTA To Comparator To A/D Converter Note 1: Comparator mode and ANSEL determines Analog Input mode. © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 35 PIC16F684 FIGURE 4-2: Data Bus D WR WPUA BLOCK DIAGRAM OF RA1 Q VDD CK Q • • • • • Weak RAPU D WR PORTA Data Bus I/O Pin WR TRISA Q CK Q VSS Analog(1) Input Mode RD TRISA D WR WPUA Q CK Q Q Weak VDD Q CK Q C1OUT 1 0 D Q3 D EN Interrupt-onChange RD PORTA To Comparator To A/D Converter 1: Q D EN RD IOCA VDD RAPU WR PORTA Q CK Q WR IOCA Analog(1) Input Mode RD WPUA D D BLOCK DIAGRAM OF RA2 C1OUT Enable RD PORTA Note a general purpose I/O an analog input for the ADC the clock input for TMR0 an external edge triggered interrupt a digital output from Comparator 1 FIGURE 4-3: VDD Q CK Q D RA2/AN2/T0CKI/INT/C1OUT Figure 4-3 shows the diagram for this pin. The RA2 pin is configurable to function as one of the following: Analog(1) Input Mode RD WPUA 4.2.5.3 Comparator mode and ANSEL determines Analog Input mode. WR TRISA I/O Pin Q CK Q VSS Analog(1) Input Mode RD TRISA RD PORTA Q D CK WR IOCA Q D Q EN RD IOCA Q Q3 D EN Interrupt-onChange RD PORTA To Timer0 To INT To A/D Converter Note DS41202F-page 36 1: Analog Input mode is generated by ANSEL. © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 4.2.5.4 RA3/MCLR/VPP 4.2.5.5 RA4/AN3/T1G/OSC2/CLKOUT Figure 4-4 shows the diagram for this pin. The RA3 pin is configurable to function as one of the following: Figure 4-5 shows the diagram for this pin. The RA4 pin is configurable to function as one of the following: • a general purpose input • as Master Clear Reset with weak pull-up • • • • • FIGURE 4-4: BLOCK DIAGRAM OF RA3 VDD MCLRE Data Bus Input Pin MCLRE RD PORTA WR IOCA CK BLOCK DIAGRAM OF RA4 Analog(3) Input Mode MCLRE VSS D FIGURE 4-5: Weak Reset RD TRISA a general purpose I/O an analog input for the ADC a Timer1 gate (count enable) a crystal/resonator connection a clock output VSS Q Q Data Bus WR WPUA D CK Q VDD Q Weak RAPU RD WPUA D Oscillator Circuit Q EN CLK(1) Modes OSC1 Q3 VDD CLKOUT Enable RD IOCA Q D D EN Interrupt-onChange WR PORTA CK Q FOSC/4 1 0 I/O Pin Q CLKOUT Enable RD PORTA VSS D WR TRISA CK Q Q INTOSC/ RC/EC(2) CLKOUT Enable RD TRISA Analog Input Mode RD PORTA D WR IOCA CK Q Q D Q EN RD IOCA Q Interrupt-onChange Q3 D EN RD PORTA To T1G To A/D Converter Note 1: CLK modes are XT, HS, LP, LPTMR1 and CLKOUT Enable. 2: With CLKOUT option. 3: Analog Input mode comes from ANSEL. © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 37 PIC16F684 4.2.5.6 RA5/T1CKI/OSC1/CLKIN Figure 4-6 shows the diagram for this pin. The RA5 pin is configurable to function as one of the following: • • • • a general purpose I/O a Timer1 clock input a crystal/resonator connection a clock input FIGURE 4-6: BLOCK DIAGRAM OF RA5 INTOSC Mode Data Bus WR WPUA D TMR1LPEN(1) VDD Q CK Weak Q RAPU RD WPUA Oscillator Circuit OSC2 D WR PORTA VDD Q CK Q I/O Pin Q D WR TRISA CK Q VSS INTOSC Mode RD TRISA RD PORTA Q D WR IOCA CK Q D Q EN Q3 RD IOCA Q D EN Interrupt-onChange RD PORTA To Timer1 Note 1: Timer1 LP Oscillator enabled. DS41202F-page 38 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 TABLE 4-1: Name SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH PORTA Bit 7 ANSEL CMCON0 PCON INTCON IOCA Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Value on: POR, BOR Value on all other Resets ANS7 ANS6 ANS5 ANS4 ANS3 ANS2 ANS1 ANS0 1111 1111 1111 1111 C2OUT C1OUT C2INV C1INV CIS CM2 CM1 CM0 0000 0000 0000 0000 — — ULPWUE SBOREN — — POR BOR --01 --qq --0u --uu GIE PEIE T0IE INTE RAIE T0IF INTF RAIF 0000 0000 0000 0000 --00 0000 — — IOCA5 IOCA4 IOCA3 IOCA2 IOCA1 IOCA0 --00 0000 RAPU INTEDG T0CS T0SE PSA PS2 PS1 PS0 1111 1111 1111 1111 PORTA — — RA5 RA4 RA3 RA2 RA1 RA0 --x0 x000 --uu uu00 TRISA — — TRISA5 TRISA4 TRISA3 TRISA2 TRISA1 TRISA0 --11 1111 --11 1111 WPUA — — WPUA5 WPUA4 — WPUA2 WPUA1 WPUA0 --11 -111 --11 -111 OPTION_REG Legend: x = unknown, u = unchanged, – = unimplemented locations read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used by PORTA. © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 39 PIC16F684 4.3 EXAMPLE 4-3: PORTC PORTC is a general purpose I/O port consisting of 6 bidirectional pins. The pins can be configured for either digital I/O or analog input to A/D Converter (ADC) or Comparator. For specific information about individual functions such as the Enhanced CCP or the ADC, refer to the appropriate section in this data sheet. Note: The ANSEL and CMCON0 registers must be initialized to configure an analog channel as a digital input. Pins configured as analog inputs will read ‘0’. REGISTER 4-6: BANKSEL CLRF MOVLW MOVWF BANKSEL CLRF MOVLW MOVWF PORTC PORTC 07h CMCON0 ANSEL ANSEL 0Ch TRISC BCF STATUS,RP0 INITIALIZING PORTC ; ;Init PORTC ;Set RC<4,1:0> to ;digital I/O ; ;digital I/O ;Set RC<3:2> as inputs ;and set RC<5:4,1:0> ;as outputs ;Bank 0 PORTC: PORTC REGISTER U-0 U-0 R/W-x R/W-x R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — — RC5 RC4 RC3 RC2 RC1 RC0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 7-6 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 5-0 RC<5:0>: PORTC I/O Pin bit 1 = PORTC pin is > VIH 0 = PORTC pin is < VIL REGISTER 4-7: x = Bit is unknown TRISC: PORTC TRI-STATE REGISTER U-0 U-0 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 — — TRISC5 TRISC4 TRISC3 TRISC2 TRISC1 TRISC0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 7-6 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 5-0 TRISC<5:0>: PORTC Tri-State Control bit 1 = PORTC pin configured as an input (tri-stated) 0 = PORTC pin configured as an output DS41202F-page 40 x = Bit is unknown © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 4.3.1 RC0/AN4/C2IN+ 4.3.3 RC2/AN6/P1D The RC0 is configurable to function as one of the following: The RC2 is configurable to function as one of the following: • a general purpose I/O • an analog input for the ADC • an analog non-inverting input to the comparator • a general purpose I/O • an analog input for the ADC • a digital output from the Enhanced CCP 4.3.2 4.3.4 RC1/AN5/C2IN- RC3/AN7/P1C The RC1 is configurable to function as one of the following: The RC3 is configurable to function as one of the following: • a general purpose I/O • an analog input for the ADC • an analog inverting input to the comparator • a general purpose I/O • an analog input for the ADC • a digital output from the Enhanced CCP FIGURE 4-7: FIGURE 4-8: BLOCK DIAGRAM OF RC0 AND RC1 Data Bus Data Bus D WR PORTC BLOCK DIAGRAM OF RC2 AND RC3 CK CCPOUT Enable VDD Q D WR PORTC Q CK VDD Q Q CCPOUT 0 I/O Pin D WR TRISC CK Q D Q VSS Analog Input Mode(1) RD TRISC 1 WR TRISC CK I/O Pin Q Q VSS Analog Input Mode(1) RD TRISC RD PORTC RD PORTC To Comparators To A/D Converter To A/D Converter Note Note 1: 1: Analog Input mode comes from ANSEL. Analog Input mode comes from ANSEL or Comparator mode. © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 41 PIC16F684 4.3.5 RC4/C2OUT/P1B 4.3.6 RC5/CCP1/P1A The RC4 is configurable to function as one of the following: The RC5 is configurable to function as one of the following: • a general purpose I/O • a digital output from the comparator • a digital output from the Enhanced CCP • a general purpose I/O • a digital input/output for the Enhanced CCP Note: Enabling both C2OUT and P1B will cause a conflict on RC4 and create unpredictable results. Therefore, if C2OUT is enabled, the ECCP can not be used in Half-Bridge or Full-Bridge mode and vice-versa. FIGURE 4-9: BLOCK DIAGRAM OF RC4 FIGURE 4-10: Data bus D WR PORTC D VDD C2OUT EN C2OUT Q VDD CCP1OUT 1 WR TRISC CK I/O Pin Q Q VSS 1 CCPOUT EN CCPOUT 0 Data Bus WR PORTC CK CCP1OUT Enable Q 0 C2OUT EN CCPOUT EN D BLOCK DIAGRAM OF RC5 PIN RD TRISC I/O Pin Q CK Q RD PORTC VSS To Enhanced CCP D WR TRISC Q CK Q RD TRISC RD PORTC Note 1: Port/Peripheral Select signals selects between port data and peripheral output. TABLE 4-2: Name ANSEL CMCON0 PORTC TRISC Legend: SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH PORTC Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Value on: POR, BOR Value on all other Resets 1111 1111 ANS7 ANS6 ANS5 ANS4 ANS3 ANS2 ANS1 ANS0 1111 1111 C2OUT C1OUT C2INV C1INV CIS CM2 CM1 CM0 0000 0000 0000 0000 — — RC5 RC4 RC3 RC2 RC1 RC0 --xx 0000 --uu uu00 — — TRISC5 TRISC4 TRISC3 TRISC2 TRISC1 TRISC0 --11 1111 --11 1111 x = unknown, u = unchanged, – = unimplemented locations read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used by PORTC. DS41202F-page 42 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 5.0 TIMER0 MODULE 5.1 Timer0 Operation The Timer0 module is an 8-bit timer/counter with the following features: When used as a timer, the Timer0 module can be used as either an 8-bit timer or an 8-bit counter. • • • • • 5.1.1 8-bit timer/counter register (TMR0) 8-bit prescaler (shared with Watchdog Timer) Programmable internal or external clock source Programmable external clock edge selection Interrupt on overflow 8-BIT TIMER MODE When used as a timer, the Timer0 module will increment every instruction cycle (without prescaler). Timer mode is selected by clearing the T0CS bit of the OPTION register to ‘0’. Figure 5-1 is a block diagram of the Timer0 module. When TMR0 is written, the increment is inhibited for two instruction cycles immediately following the write. Note: 5.1.2 The value written to the TMR0 register can be adjusted, in order to account for the two instruction cycle delay when TMR0 is written. 8-BIT COUNTER MODE When used as a counter, the Timer0 module will increment on every rising or falling edge of the T0CKI pin. The incrementing edge is determined by the T0SE bit of the OPTION register. Counter mode is selected by setting the T0CS bit of the OPTION register to ‘1’. FIGURE 5-1: BLOCK DIAGRAM OF THE TIMER0/WDT PRESCALER FOSC/4 Data Bus 0 8 1 Sync 2 cycles 1 T0CKI pin TMR0 0 0 T0CS T0SE Set Flag bit T0IF on Overflow 8-bit Prescaler PSA 1 8 PSA WDTE SWDTEN 3 PS<2:0> 16-bit Prescaler 31 kHz INTOSC 1 WDT Time-out 0 16 Watchdog Timer PSA WDTPS<3:0> Note 1: T0SE, T0CS, PSA, PS<2:0> are bits in the OPTION register. 2: SWDTEN and WDTPS<3:0> are bits in the WDTCON register. 3: WDTE bit is in the Configuration Word register. © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 43 PIC16F684 5.1.3 SOFTWARE PROGRAMMABLE PRESCALER A single software programmable prescaler is available for use with either Timer0 or the Watchdog Timer (WDT), but not both simultaneously. The prescaler assignment is controlled by the PSA bit of the OPTION register. To assign the prescaler to Timer0, the PSA bit must be cleared to a ‘0’. There are 8 prescaler options for the Timer0 module ranging from 1:2 to 1:256. The prescale values are selectable via the PS<2:0> bits of the OPTION register. In order to have a 1:1 prescaler value for the Timer0 module, the prescaler must be assigned to the WDT module. The prescaler is not readable or writable. When assigned to the Timer0 module, all instructions writing to the TMR0 register will clear the prescaler. When the prescaler is assigned to WDT, a CLRWDT instruction will clear the prescaler along with the WDT. 5.1.3.1 Switching Prescaler Between Timer0 and WDT Modules As a result of having the prescaler assigned to either Timer0 or the WDT, it is possible to generate an unintended device Reset when switching prescaler values. When changing the prescaler assignment from Timer0 to the WDT module, the instruction sequence shown in Example 5-1 must be executed. EXAMPLE 5-1: BANKSEL CLRWDT CLRF CHANGING PRESCALER (TIMER0 → WDT) TMR0 TMR0 BANKSEL BSF CLRWDT OPTION_REG OPTION_REG,PSA MOVLW ANDWF IORLW MOVWF b’11111000’ OPTION_REG,W b’00000101’ OPTION_REG DS41202F-page 44 ; ;Clear WDT ;Clear TMR0 and ; prescaler ; ;Select WDT ; ; ;Mask prescaler ; bits ;Set WDT prescaler ; to 1:32 When changing the prescaler assignment from the WDT to the Timer0 module, the following instruction sequence must be executed (see Example 5-2). EXAMPLE 5-2: CHANGING PRESCALER (WDT → TIMER0) CLRWDT ;Clear WDT and ;prescaler BANKSEL OPTION_REG ; MOVLW b’11110000’ ;Mask TMR0 select and ANDWF OPTION_REG,W ; prescaler bits IORLW b’00000011’ ;Set prescale to 1:16 MOVWF OPTION_REG ; 5.1.4 TIMER0 INTERRUPT Timer0 will generate an interrupt when the TMR0 register overflows from FFh to 00h. The T0IF interrupt flag bit of the INTCON register is set every time the TMR0 register overflows, regardless of whether or not the Timer0 interrupt is enabled. The T0IF bit must be cleared in software. The Timer0 interrupt enable is the T0IE bit of the INTCON register. Note: 5.1.5 The Timer0 interrupt cannot wake the processor from Sleep since the timer is frozen during Sleep. USING TIMER0 WITH AN EXTERNAL CLOCK When Timer0 is in Counter mode, the synchronization of the T0CKI input and the Timer0 register is accomplished by sampling the prescaler output on the Q2 and Q4 cycles of the internal phase clocks. Therefore, the high and low periods of the external clock source must meet the timing requirements as shown in Section 15.0 “Electrical Specifications”. © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 REGISTER 5-1: OPTION_REG: OPTION REGISTER R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 RAPU INTEDG T0CS T0SE PSA PS2 PS1 PS0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 7 RAPU: PORTA Pull-up Enable bit 1 = PORTA pull-ups are disabled 0 = PORTA pull-ups are enabled by individual PORT latch values bit 6 INTEDG: Interrupt Edge Select bit 1 = Interrupt on rising edge of INT pin 0 = Interrupt on falling edge of INT pin bit 5 T0CS: TMR0 Clock Source Select bit 1 = Transition on T0CKI pin 0 = Internal instruction cycle clock (FOSC/4) bit 4 T0SE: TMR0 Source Edge Select bit 1 = Increment on high-to-low transition on T0CKI pin 0 = Increment on low-to-high transition on T0CKI pin bit 3 PSA: Prescaler Assignment bit 1 = Prescaler is assigned to the WDT 0 = Prescaler is assigned to the Timer0 module bit 2-0 PS<2:0>: Prescaler Rate Select bits BIT VALUE 000 001 010 011 100 101 110 111 Note 1: WDT RATE 1:2 1:4 1:8 1 : 16 1 : 32 1 : 64 1 : 128 1 : 256 1:1 1:2 1:4 1:8 1 : 16 1 : 32 1 : 64 1 : 128 A dedicated 16-bit WDT postscaler is available. See Section 12.6 “Watchdog Timer (WDT)” for more information. TABLE 5-1: Name TMR0 INTCON OPTION_REG TRISA TMR0 RATE x = Bit is unknown SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH TIMER0 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Value on: POR, BOR T0IE INTE RAIE T0IF INTF RAIF 0000 0000 0000 0000 T0CS T0SE PSA PS2 PS1 PS0 1111 1111 1111 1111 Timer0 Module Register GIE PEIE RAPU INTEDG — — Value on all other Resets Bit 4 Bit 5 xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu TRISA5 TRISA4 TRISA3 TRISA2 TRISA1 TRISA0 --11 1111 --11 1111 Legend: – = Unimplemented locations, read as ‘0’, u = unchanged, x = unknown. Shaded cells are not used by the Timer0 module. © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 45 PIC16F684 NOTES: DS41202F-page 46 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 6.0 TIMER1 MODULE WITH GATE CONTROL 6.1 The Timer1 module is a 16-bit incrementing counter which is accessed through the TMR1H:TMR1L register pair. Writes to TMR1H or TMR1L directly update the counter. The Timer1 module is a 16-bit timer/counter with the following features: • • • • • • • • • • • Timer1 Operation 16-bit timer/counter register pair (TMR1H:TMR1L) Programmable internal or external clock source 3-bit prescaler Optional LP oscillator Synchronous or asynchronous operation Timer1 gate (count enable) via comparator or T1G pin Interrupt on overflow Wake-up on overflow (external clock, Asynchronous mode only) Time base for the Capture/Compare function Special Event Trigger (with ECCP) Comparator output synchronization to Timer1 clock When used with an internal clock source, the module is a timer. When used with an external clock source, the module can be used as either a timer or counter. 6.2 Clock Source Selection The TMR1CS bit of the T1CON register is used to select the clock source. When TMR1CS = 0, the clock source is FOSC/4. When TMR1CS = 1, the clock source is supplied externally. Clock Source TMR1CS FOSC/4 0 T1CKI pin 1 Figure 6-1 is a block diagram of the Timer1 module. FIGURE 6-1: TIMER1 BLOCK DIAGRAM TMR1GE T1GINV TMR1ON Set flag bit TMR1IF on Overflow TMR1 TMR1H To C2 Comparator Module Timer1 Clock (1) TMR1L Synchronized clock input 0 EN 1 Oscillator OSC1/T1CKI T1SYNC * 1 FOSC/4 Internal Clock OSC2/T1G Prescaler 1, 2, 4, 8 Synchronize det(2) 0 2 T1CKPS<1:0> TMR1CS 1 T1OSCEN C2OUT FOSC = 100 0 FOSC = 000 T1GSS Sleep * Note 1: 2: ST Buffer is low power type when using LP osc, or high speed type when using T1CKI. Timer1 register increments on rising edge. Synchronize does not operate while in Sleep. © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 47 PIC16F684 6.2.1 INTERNAL CLOCK SOURCE When the internal clock source is selected, the TMR1H:TMR1L register pair will increment on multiples of FOSC as determined by the Timer1 prescaler. 6.2.2 TRISA5 and TRISA4 bits are set when the Timer1 oscillator is enabled. RA5 and RA4 bits read as ‘0’ and TRISA5 and TRISA4 bits read as ‘1’. Note: EXTERNAL CLOCK SOURCE When the external clock source is selected, the Timer1 module may work as a timer or a counter. When counting, Timer1 is incremented on the rising edge of the external clock input T1CKI. In addition, the Counter mode clock can be synchronized to the microcontroller system clock or run asynchronously. If an external clock oscillator is needed (and the microcontroller is using the INTOSC without CLKOUT), Timer1 can use the LP oscillator as a clock source. Note: In Counter mode, a falling edge must be registered by the counter prior to the first incrementing rising edge after any one or more of the following conditions: • • • • Timer1 enabled after POR reset Write to TMR1H or TMR1L Timer1 is disabled Timer1 is disabled (TMR1ON 0) when T1CKI is high then Timer1 is enabled (TMR1ON=1) when T1CKI is low. 6.5 The oscillator requires a start-up and stabilization time before use. Thus, T1OSCEN should be set and a suitable delay observed prior to enabling Timer1. Timer1 Operation in Asynchronous Counter Mode If control bit T1SYNC of the T1CON register is set, the external clock input is not synchronized. The timer increments asynchronously to the internal phase clocks. If external clock source is selected then the timer will continue to run during Sleep and can generate an interrupt on overflow, which will wake-up the processor. However, special precautions in software are needed to read/write the timer (see Section 6.5.1 “Reading and Writing Timer1 in Asynchronous Counter Mode”). Note: When switching from synchronous to asynchronous operation, it is possible to skip an increment. When switching from asynchronous to synchronous operation, it is possible to produce an additional increment. See Figure 6-2 6.5.1 6.3 Timer1 Prescaler Timer1 has four prescaler options allowing 1, 2, 4 or 8 divisions of the clock input. The T1CKPS bits of the T1CON register control the prescale counter. The prescale counter is not directly readable or writable; however, the prescaler counter is cleared upon a write to TMR1H or TMR1L. 6.4 Timer1 Oscillator A low-power 32.768 kHz crystal oscillator is built-in between pins OSC1 (input) and OSC2 (amplifier output). The oscillator is enabled by setting the T1OSCEN control bit of the T1CON register. The oscillator will continue to run during Sleep. READING AND WRITING TIMER1 IN ASYNCHRONOUS COUNTER MODE Reading TMR1H or TMR1L while the timer is running from an external asynchronous clock will ensure a valid read (taken care of in hardware). However, the user should keep in mind that reading the 16-bit timer in two 8-bit values itself, poses certain problems, since the timer may overflow or carry out of TMR1L to TMR1H between the reads. For writes, it is recommended that the user simply stop the timer and write the desired values. A write contention may occur by writing to the timer registers, while the register is incrementing. This may produce an unpredictable value in the TMR1H:TMR1L register pair. The Timer1 oscillator is shared with the system LP oscillator. Thus, Timer1 can use this mode only when the primary system clock is derived from the internal oscillator or when the oscillator is in the LP mode. The user must provide a software time delay to ensure proper oscillator start-up. DS41202F-page 48 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 6.6 Timer1 Gate Timer1 gate source is software configurable to be the T1G pin or the output of Comparator 2. This allows the device to directly time external events using T1G or analog events using Comparator 2. See the CMCON1 register (Register 8-2) for selecting the Timer1 gate source. This feature can simplify the software for a Delta-Sigma A/D converter and many other applications. For more information on Delta-Sigma A/D converters, see the Microchip web site (www.microchip.com). Note: TMR1GE bit of the T1CON register must be set to use either T1G or C2OUT as the Timer1 gate source. See the CMCON1 register (Register 8-2) for more information on selecting the Timer1 gate source. Timer1 gate can be inverted using the T1GINV bit of the T1CON register, whether it originates from the T1G pin or Comparator 2 output. This configures Timer1 to measure either the active-high or active-low time between events. 6.7 Timer1 Interrupt The Timer1 register pair (TMR1H:TMR1L) increments to FFFFh and rolls over to 0000h. When Timer1 rolls over, the Timer1 interrupt flag bit of the PIR1 register is set. To enable the interrupt on rollover, you must set these bits: • • • • TMR1ON bit or the T1CON register TMR1IE bit of the PIE1 register PEIE bit of the INTCON register GIE bit of the INTCON register The interrupt is cleared by clearing the TMR1IF bit in the Interrupt Service Routine. Note: 6.8 The TMR1H:TTMR1L register pair and the TMR1IF bit should be cleared before enabling interrupts. Timer1 Operation During Sleep 6.9 ECCP Capture/Compare Time Base The ECCP module uses the TMR1H:TMR1L register pair as the time base when operating in Capture or Compare mode. In Capture mode, the value in the TMR1H:TMR1L register pair is copied into the CCPR1H:CCPR1L register pair on a configured event. In Compare mode, an event is triggered when the value CCPR1H:CCPR1L register pair matches the value in the TMR1H:TMR1L register pair. This event can be a Special Event Trigger. For more information, see Section 11.0 “Enhanced Capture/Compare/PWM (With Auto-Shutdown and Dead Band) Module”. 6.10 ECCP Special Event Trigger When the ECCP is configured to trigger a special event, the trigger will clear the TMR1H:TMR1L register pair. This special event does not cause a Timer1 interrupt. The ECCP module may still be configured to generate a ECCP interrupt. In this mode of operation, the CCPR1H:CCPR1L register pair effectively becomes the period register for Timer1. Timer1 should be synchronized to the FOSC to utilize the Special Event Trigger. Asynchronous operation of Timer1 can cause a Special Event Trigger to be missed. In the event that a write to TMR1H or TMR1L coincides with a Special Event Trigger from the ECCP, the write will take precedence. For more information, see Section 11.2.4 “Special Event Trigger”. 6.11 Comparator Synchronization The same clock used to increment Timer1 can also be used to synchronize the comparator output. This feature is enabled in the Comparator module. Timer1 can only operate during Sleep when setup in Asynchronous Counter mode. In this mode, an external crystal or clock source can be used to increment the counter. To set up the timer to wake the device: When using the comparator for Timer1 gate, the comparator output should be synchronized to Timer1. This ensures Timer1 does not miss an increment if the comparator changes. • • • • • • For more information, see Section 8.9 “Synchronizing Comparator C2 Output to Timer1”. TMR1ON bit of the T1CON register must be set TMR1IE bit of the PIE1 register must be set PEIE bit of the INTCON register must be set T1SYNC bit of the T1CON register TMR1CS bit of the T1CON register T1OSCEN bit of the T1CON register (can be set) The device will wake-up on an overflow and execute the next instruction. If the GIE bit of the INTCON register is set, the device will call the Interrupt Service Routine (0004h). © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 49 PIC16F684 FIGURE 6-2: TIMER1 INCREMENTING EDGE T1CKI = 1 when TMR1 Enabled T1CKI = 0 when TMR1 Enabled Note 1: Arrows indicate counter increments. 2: 6.12 In Counter mode, a falling edge must be registered by the counter prior to the first incrementing rising edge of the clock. Timer1 Control Register The Timer1 Control register (T1CON), shown in Register 6-1, is used to control Timer1 and select the various features of the Timer1 module. REGISTER 6-1: R/W-0 (1) T1GINV T1CON: TIMER 1 CONTROL REGISTER R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 TMR1GE(2) T1CKPS1 T1CKPS0 T1OSCEN T1SYNC TMR1CS TMR1ON bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 7 T1GINV: Timer1 Gate Invert bit(1) 1 = Timer1 gate is active high (Timer1 counts when gate is high) 0 = Timer1 gate is active low (Timer1 counts when gate is low) bit 6 TMR1GE: Timer1 Gate Enable bit(2) If TMR1ON = 0: This bit is ignored If TMR1ON = 1: 1 = Timer1 is on if Timer1 gate is not active 0 = Timer1 is on bit 5-4 T1CKPS<1:0>: Timer1 Input Clock Prescale Select bits 11 = 1:8 Prescale Value 10 = 1:4 Prescale Value 01 = 1:2 Prescale Value 00 = 1:1 Prescale Value bit 3 T1OSCEN: LP Oscillator Enable Control bit If INTOSC without CLKOUT oscillator is active: 1 = LP oscillator is enabled for Timer1 clock 0 = LP oscillator is off Else: This bit is ignored DS41202F-page 50 x = Bit is unknown © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 REGISTER 6-1: T1CON: TIMER 1 CONTROL REGISTER (CONTINUED) bit 2 T1SYNC: Timer1 External Clock Input Synchronization Control bit TMR1CS = 1: 1 = Do not synchronize external clock input 0 = Synchronize external clock input TMR1CS = 0: This bit is ignored. Timer1 uses the internal clock bit 1 TMR1CS: Timer1 Clock Source Select bit 1 = External clock from T1CKI pin (on the rising edge) 0 = Internal clock (FOSC/4) bit 0 TMR1ON: Timer1 On bit 1 = Enables Timer1 0 = Stops Timer1 Note 1: 2: T1GINV bit inverts the Timer1 gate logic, regardless of source. TMR1GE bit must be set to use either T1G pin or C2OUT, as selected by the T1GSS bit of the CMCON1 register, as a Timer1 gate source. TABLE 6-1: Name SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH TIMER1 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Value on: POR, BOR Value on all other Resets CMCON1 — — — — — — T1GSS C2SYNC ---- --10 ---- --10 INTCON GIE PEIE T0IE INTE RAIE T0IF INTF RAIF 0000 0000 0000 0000 PIE1 EEIE ADIE CCP1IE C2IE C1IE OSFIE TMR2IE TMR1IE 0000 0000 0000 0000 PIR1 EEIF ADIF CCP1IF C2IF C1IF OSFIF TMR2IF TMR1IF 0000 0000 0000 0000 uuuu uuuu TMR1H Holding Register for the Most Significant Byte of the 16-bit TMR1 Register xxxx xxxx TMR1L Holding Register for the Least Significant Byte of the 16-bit TMR1 Register xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu 0000 0000 uuuu uuuu T1CON Legend: T1GINV TMR1GE T1CKPS1 T1CKPS0 T1OSCEN T1SYNC TMR1CS TMR1ON x = unknown, u = unchanged, — = unimplemented, read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used by the Timer1 module. © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 51 PIC16F684 NOTES: DS41202F-page 52 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 7.0 TIMER2 MODULE The Timer2 module is an eight-bit timer with the following features: • • • • • 8-bit timer register (TMR2) 8-bit period register (PR2) Interrupt on TMR2 match with PR2 Software programmable prescaler (1:1, 1:4, 1:16) Software programmable postscaler (1:1 to 1:16) Timer2 is turned on by setting the TMR2ON bit in the T2CON register to a ‘1’. Timer2 is turned off by clearing the TMR2ON bit to a ‘0’. The Timer2 prescaler is controlled by the T2CKPS bits in the T2CON register. The Timer2 postscaler is controlled by the TOUTPS bits in the T2CON register. The prescaler and postscaler counters are cleared when: See Figure 7-1 for a block diagram of Timer2. 7.1 The TMR2 and PR2 registers are both fully readable and writable. On any Reset, the TMR2 register is set to 00h and the PR2 register is set to FFh. Timer2 Operation The clock input to the Timer2 module is the system instruction clock (FOSC/4). The clock is fed into the Timer2 prescaler, which has prescale options of 1:1, 1:4 or 1:16. The output of the prescaler is then used to increment the TMR2 register. • A write to TMR2 occurs. • A write to T2CON occurs. • Any device Reset occurs (Power-on Reset, MCLR Reset, Watchdog Timer Reset, or Brown-out Reset). Note: The values of TMR2 and PR2 are constantly compared to determine when they match. TMR2 will increment from 00h until it matches the value in PR2. When a match occurs, two things happen: TMR2 is not cleared when T2CON is written. • TMR2 is reset to 00h on the next increment cycle. • The Timer2 postscaler is incremented The match output of the Timer2/PR2 comparator is fed into the Timer2 postscaler. The postscaler has postscale options of 1:1 to 1:16 inclusive. The output of the Timer2 postscaler is used to set the TMR2IF interrupt flag bit in the PIR1 register. FIGURE 7-1: TIMER2 BLOCK DIAGRAM TMR2 Output FOSC/4 Prescaler 1:1, 1:4, 1:16 2 TMR2 Sets Flag bit TMR2IF Reset Comparator EQ Postscaler 1:1 to 1:16 T2CKPS<1:0> PR2 4 TOUTPS<3:0> © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 53 PIC16F684 REGISTER 7-1: T2CON: TIMER 2 CONTROL REGISTER U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — TOUTPS3 TOUTPS2 TOUTPS1 TOUTPS0 TMR2ON T2CKPS1 T2CKPS0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 7 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 6-3 TOUTPS<3:0>: Timer2 Output Postscaler Select bits 0000 = 1:1 Postscaler 0001 = 1:2 Postscaler 0010 = 1:3 Postscaler 0011 = 1:4 Postscaler 0100 = 1:5 Postscaler 0101 = 1:6 Postscaler 0110 = 1:7 Postscaler 0111 = 1:8 Postscaler 1000 = 1:9 Postscaler 1001 = 1:10 Postscaler 1010 = 1:11 Postscaler 1011 = 1:12 Postscaler 1100 = 1:13 Postscaler 1101 = 1:14 Postscaler 1110 = 1:15 Postscaler 1111 = 1:16 Postscaler bit 2 TMR2ON: Timer2 On bit 1 = Timer2 is on 0 = Timer2 is off bit 1-0 T2CKPS<1:0>: Timer2 Clock Prescale Select bits 00 = Prescaler is 1 01 = Prescaler is 4 1x = Prescaler is 16 TABLE 7-1: x = Bit is unknown SUMMARY OF ASSOCIATED TIMER2 REGISTERS Name Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Value on: POR, BOR Value on all other Resets INTCON GIE PEIE T0IE INTE RAIE T0IF INTF RAIF 0000 0000 0000 0000 PIE1 EEIE ADIE CCP1IE C2IE C1IE OSFIE TMR2IE TMR1IE 0000 0000 0000 0000 PIR1 EEIF ADIF CCP1IF C2IF C1IF OSFIF TMR2IF TMR1IF 0000 0000 0000 0000 PR2 Timer2 Module Period Register 1111 1111 1111 1111 TMR2 Holding Register for the 8-bit TMR2 Register 0000 0000 0000 0000 -000 0000 -000 0000 T2CON — Legend: x = unknown, u = unchanged, — = unimplemented read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used for Timer2 module. DS41202F-page 54 TOUTPS3 TOUTPS2 TOUTPS1 TOUTPS0 TMR2ON T2CKPS1 T2CKPS0 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 8.0 COMPARATOR MODULE 8.1 Comparator Overview Comparators are used to interface analog circuits to a digital circuit by comparing two analog voltages and providing a digital indication of their relative magnitudes. The comparators are very useful mixed signal building blocks because they provide analog functionality independent of the device program execution. The analog Comparator module includes the following features: A comparator is shown in Figure 8-1 along with the relationship between the analog input levels and the digital output. When the analog voltage at VIN+ is less than the analog voltage at VIN-, the output of the comparator is a digital low level. When the analog voltage at VIN+ is greater than the analog voltage at VIN-, the output of the comparator is a digital high level. • Dual comparators • Multiple comparator configurations • Comparator outputs are available internally/ externally • Programmable output polarity • Interrupt-on-change • Wake-up from Sleep • Timer1 gate (count enable) • Output synchronization to Timer1 clock input • Programmable voltage reference FIGURE 8-1: Note: SINGLE COMPARATOR VIN+ + VIN- – Output VINVIN+ Only Comparator C2 can be linked to Timer1. Output Note: The black areas of the output of the comparator represents the uncertainty due to input offsets and response time. This device contains two comparators as shown in Figure 8-2 and Figure 8-3. The comparators are not independently configurable. © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 55 PIC16F684 FIGURE 8-2: COMPARATOR C1 OUTPUT BLOCK DIAGRAM MULTIPLEX Port Pins C1INV To C1OUT pin C1 D Q1 To Data Bus Q EN RD CMCON0 Set C1IF bit D Q3*RD CMCON0 Q EN CL Reset Note 1: 2: FIGURE 8-3: Q1 and Q3 are phases of the four-phase system clock (FOSC). Q1 is held high during Sleep mode. COMPARATOR C2 OUTPUT BLOCK DIAGRAM C2SYNC Port Pins MULTIPLEX To Timer1 Gate C2INV 0 C2 To C2OUT pin D Q D Q 1 Timer1 clock source(1) Q1 EN To Data Bus RD CMCON0 Set C2IF bit D Q3*RD CMCON0 Q EN CL Reset Note 1: DS41202F-page 56 Comparator output is latched on falling edge of Timer1 clock source. 2: Q1 and Q3 are phases of the four-phase system clock (FOSC). 3: Q1 is held high during Sleep mode. © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 8.1.1 ANALOG INPUT CONNECTION CONSIDERATIONS A simplified circuit for an analog input is shown in Figure 8-4. Since the analog input pins share their connection with a digital input, they have reverse biased ESD protection diodes to VDD and VSS. The analog input, therefore, must be between VSS and VDD. If the input voltage deviates from this range by more than 0.6V in either direction, one of the diodes is forward biased and a latch-up may occur. Note 1: When reading a PORT register, all pins configured as analog inputs will read as a ‘0’. Pins configured as digital inputs will convert as an analog input, according to the input specification. 2: Analog levels on any pin defined as a digital input, may cause the input buffer to consume more current than is specified. A maximum source impedance of 10 kΩ is recommended for the analog sources. Also, any external component connected to an analog input pin, such as a capacitor or a Zener diode, should have very little leakage current to minimize inaccuracies introduced. FIGURE 8-4: ANALOG INPUT MODEL VDD VT ≈ 0.6V Rs < 10K RIC To ADC Input AIN VA CPIN 5 pF VT ≈ 0.6V ILEAKAGE ±500 nA Vss Legend: CPIN = Input Capacitance ILEAKAGE = Leakage Current at the pin due to various junctions = Interconnect Resistance RIC = Source Impedance RS VA = Analog Voltage = Threshold Voltage VT © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 57 PIC16F684 8.2 Comparator Configuration There are eight modes of operation for the comparator. The CM<2:0> bits of the CMCON0 register are used to select these modes as shown in Figure 8-5. I/O lines change as a function of the mode and are designated as follows: • Analog function (A): digital input buffer is disabled • Digital function (D): comparator digital output, overrides port function • Normal port function (I/O): independent of comparator FIGURE 8-5: VIN+ C1IN+ A C2IN- C1 Off(1) C2 Off(1) C1IN+ VIN+ C2INC2IN+ Three Inputs Multiplexed to Two Comparators CM<2:0> = 001 A C2INC2IN+ A CIS = 0 CIS = 1 VINC1 VIN+ A VIN- A VIN+ C1OUT C2 C2OUT C1IN+ A A CIS = 0 CIS = 1 VINVIN+ C1 A VIN+ A VIN- A VIN+ C1IN+ C2IN+ I/O VIN+ A VIN- A VIN+ C2IN+ C2 C2OUT C1 Off(1) C2 C2OUT VIN+ C1OUT C1 C1OUT C2 C2OUT D A A CIS = 0 CIS = 1 VINVIN+ C2 C2OUT C2INC2IN+ I/O VIN+ A VIN- A VIN+ C1 C2OUT(pin) C1OUT C2OUT Legend: A = Analog Input, ports always reads ‘0’ I/O = Normal port I/O VIN- A VIN+ D C1IN+ I/O C2IN- C2 A Comparators Off (Lowest Power) CM<2:0> = 111 I/O VINC1IN- Two Common Reference Comparators CM<2:0> = 011 A VINC1INC1IN+ C2INC2IN+ From CVREF Module Note 1: C1OUT Two Common Reference Comparators with Outputs CM<2:0> = 110 A VINC1INC1OUT(pin) C2IN- C1 One Independent Comparator CM<2:0> = 101 I/O VINC1IN- C2IN- Four Inputs Multiplexed to Two Comparators CM<2:0> = 010 C1IN- Comparator interrupts should be disabled during a Comparator mode change to prevent unintended interrupts. Two Independent Comparators CM<2:0> = 100 VINC1IN- A VIN- A C2IN+ A C1IN+ Note: COMPARATOR I/O OPERATING MODES Comparators Reset (POR Default Value) CM<2:0> = 000 A VINC1IN- C1IN- The port pins denoted as “A” will read as a ‘0’ regardless of the state of the I/O pin or the I/O control TRIS bit. Pins used as analog inputs should also have the corresponding TRIS bit set to ‘1’ to disable the digital output driver. Pins denoted as “D” should have the corresponding TRIS bit set to ‘0’ to enable the digital output driver. C2IN+ VIN+ I/O VIN- I/O VIN+ C1 Off(1) C2 Off(1) CIS = Comparator Input Switch (CMCON0<3>) D = Comparator Digital Output Reads as ‘0’, unless CxINV = 1. DS41202F-page 58 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 8.3 Comparator Control 8.4 The CMCON0 register (Register 8-1) provides access to the following comparator features: • • • • Mode selection Output state Output polarity Input switch 8.3.1 COMPARATOR OUTPUT STATE Each comparator state can always be read internally via the associated CxOUT bit of the CMCON0 register. The comparator outputs are directed to the CxOUT pins when CM<2:0> = 110. When this mode is selected, the TRIS bits for the associated CxOUT pins must be cleared to enable the output drivers. 8.3.2 COMPARATOR OUTPUT POLARITY Inverting the output of a comparator is functionally equivalent to swapping the comparator inputs. The polarity of a comparator output can be inverted by setting the CxINV bits of the CMCON0 register. Clearing CxINV results in a non-inverted output. A complete table showing the output state versus input conditions and the polarity bit is shown in Table 8-1. TABLE 8-1: OUTPUT STATE VS. INPUT CONDITIONS Input Conditions CxINV CxOUT VIN- > VIN+ 0 0 VIN- < VIN+ 0 1 VIN- > VIN+ 1 1 VIN- < VIN+ 1 0 Note: 8.3.3 CxOUT refers to both the register bit and output pin. COMPARATOR INPUT SWITCH The inverting input of the comparators may be switched between two analog pins in the following modes: • CM<2:0> = 001 (Comparator C1 only) • CM<2:0> = 010 (Comparators C1 and C2) In the above modes, both pins remain in Analog mode regardless of which pin is selected as the input. The CIS bit of the CMCON0 register controls the comparator input switch. Comparator Response Time The comparator output is indeterminate for a period of time after the change of an input source or the selection of a new reference voltage. This period is referred to as the response time. The response time of the comparator differs from the settling time of the voltage reference. Therefore, both of these times must be considered when determining the total response time to a comparator input change. See Comparator and Voltage Reference specifications of Section 15.0 “Electrical Specifications” for more details. 8.5 Comparator Interrupt Operation The comparator interrupt flag is set whenever there is a change in the output value of the comparator. Changes are recognized by means of a mismatch circuit which consists of two latches and an exclusiveor gate (see Figure 8-2 and Figure 8-3). One latch is updated with the comparator output level when the CMCON0 register is read. This latch retains the value until the next read of the CMCON0 register or the occurrence of a reset. The other latch of the mismatch circuit is updated on every Q1 system clock. A mismatch condition will occur when a comparator output change is clocked through the second latch on the Q1 clock cycle. The mismatch condition will persist, holding the CxIF bit of the PIR1 register true, until either the CMCON0 register is read or the comparator output returns to the previous state. Note: A write operation to the CMCON0 register will also clear the mismatch condition because all writes include a read operation at the beginning of the write cycle. Software will need to maintain information about the status of the comparator output to determine the actual change that has occurred. The CxIF bit of the PIR1 register is the comparator interrupt flag. This bit must be reset in software by clearing it to ‘0’. Since it is also possible to write a ‘1’ to this register, a simulated interrupt may be initiated. The CxIE bit of the PIE1 register and the PEIE and GIE bits of the INTCON register must all be set to enable comparator interrupts. If any of these bits are cleared, the interrupt is not enabled, although the CxIF bit of the PIR1 register will still be set if an interrupt condition occurs. The user, in the Interrupt Service Routine, can clear the interrupt in the following manner: a) b) © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. Any read or write of CMCON0. This will end the mismatch condition. Clear the CxIF interrupt flag. DS41202F-page 59 PIC16F684 A persistent mismatch condition will preclude clearing the CxIF interrupt flag. Reading CMCON0 will end the mismatch condition and allow the CxIF bit to be cleared. FIGURE 8-6: COMPARATOR INTERRUPT TIMING W/O CMCON0 READ Q1 Q3 CxIN+ TRT CxOUT Set CMIF (level) CMIF reset by software FIGURE 8-7: COMPARATOR INTERRUPT TIMING WITH CMCON0 READ Q3 TRT CxOUT Set CMIF (level) CMIF cleared by CMCON0 read Operation During Sleep The comparator, if enabled before entering Sleep mode, remains active during Sleep. The additional current consumed by the comparator is shown separately in Section 15.0 “Electrical Specifications”. If the comparator is not used to wake the device, power consumption can be minimized while in Sleep mode by turning off the comparator. The comparator is turned off by selecting mode CM<2:0> = 000 or CM<2:0> = 111 of the CMCON0 register. A change to the comparator output can wake-up the device from Sleep. To enable the comparator to wake the device from Sleep, the CxIE bit of the PIE1 register and the PEIE bit of the INTCON register must be set. The instruction following the Sleep instruction always executes following a wake from Sleep. If the GIE bit of the INTCON register is also set, the device will then execute the interrupt service routine. 8.7 Effects of a Reset A device Reset forces the CMCON0 and CMCON1 registers to their Reset states. This forces the Comparator module to be in the Comparator Reset mode (CM<2:0> = 000). Thus, all comparator inputs are analog inputs with the comparator disabled to consume the smallest current possible. Q1 CxIN+ 8.6 reset by software Note 1: If a change in the CM1CON0 register (CxOUT) should occur when a read operation is being executed (start of the Q2 cycle), then the CxIF Interrupt Flag bit of the PIR1 register may not get set. 2: When either comparator is first enabled, bias circuitry in the Comparator module may cause an invalid output from the comparator until the bias circuitry is stable. Allow about 1 μs for bias settling then clear the mismatch condition and interrupt flags before enabling comparator interrupts. DS41202F-page 60 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 REGISTER 8-1: CMCON0: COMPARATOR CONFIGURATION REGISTER R-0 R-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 C2OUT C1OUT C2INV C1INV CIS CM2 CM1 CM0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 7 C2OUT: Comparator 2 Output bit When C2INV = 0: 1 = C2 VIN+ > C2 VIN0 = C2 VIN+ < C2 VINWhen C2INV = 1: 1 = C2 VIN+ < C2 VIN0 = C2 VIN+ > C2 VIN- bit 6 C1OUT: Comparator 1 Output bit When C1INV = 0: 1 = C1 VIN+ > C1 VIN0 = C1 VIN+ < C1 VINWhen C1INV = 1: 1 = C1 VIN+ < C1 VIN0 = C1 VIN+ > C1 VIN- bit 5 C2INV: Comparator 2 Output Inversion bit 1 = C2 output inverted 0 = C2 output not inverted bit 4 C1INV: Comparator 1 Output Inversion bit 1 = C1 Output inverted 0 = C1 Output not inverted bit 3 CIS: Comparator Input Switch bit When CM<2:0> = 010: 1 = C1IN+ connects to C1 VINC2IN+ connects to C2 VIN0 = C1IN- connects to C1 VINC2IN- connects to C2 VINWhen CM<2:0> = 001: 1 = C1IN+ connects to C1 VIN0 = C1IN- connects to C1 VIN- bit 2-0 CM<2:0>: Comparator Mode bits (See Figure 8-5) 000 = Comparators off. CxIN pins are configured as analog 001 = Three inputs multiplexed to two comparators 010 = Four inputs multiplexed to two comparators 011 = Two common reference comparators 100 = Two independent comparators 101 = One independent comparator 110 = Two common reference comparators with outputs 111 = Comparators off. CxIN pins are configured as digital I/O © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. x = Bit is unknown DS41202F-page 61 PIC16F684 8.8 Comparator C2 Gating Timer1 8.9 This feature can be used to time the duration or interval of analog events. Clearing the T1GSS bit of the CMCON1 register will enable Timer1 to increment based on the output of Comparator C2. This requires that Timer1 is on and gating is enabled. See Section 6.0 “Timer1 Module with Gate Control” for details. It is recommended to synchronize Comparator C2 with Timer1 by setting the C2SYNC bit when the comparator is used as the Timer1 gate source. This ensures Timer1 does not miss an increment if the comparator changes during an increment. REGISTER 8-2: Synchronizing Comparator C2 Output to Timer1 The output of Comparator C2 can be synchronized with Timer1 by setting the C2SYNC bit of the CMCON1 register. When enabled, the comparator output is latched on the falling edge of the Timer1 clock source. If a prescaler is used with Timer1, the comparator output is latched after the prescaling function. To prevent a race condition, the comparator output is latched on the falling edge of the Timer1 clock source and Timer1 increments on the rising edge of its clock source. Reference the comparator block diagrams (Figure 8-2 and Figure 8-3) and the Timer1 Block Diagram (Figure 6-1) for more information. CMCON1: COMPARATOR CONFIGURATION REGISTER U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 R/W-1 R/W-0 — — — — — — T1GSS C2SYNC bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 7-2 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 1 T1GSS: Timer1 Gate Source Select bit(1) 1 = Timer1 gate source is T1G pin (pin should be configured as digital input) 0 = Timer1 gate source is Comparator C2 output bit 0 C2SYNC: Comparator C2 Output Synchronization bit(2) 1 = Output is synchronized with falling edge of Timer1 clock 0 = Output is asynchronous Note 1: 2: Refer to Section 6.6 “Timer1 Gate”. Refer to Figure 8-3. DS41202F-page 62 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 8.10 EQUATION 8-1: Comparator Voltage Reference V RR = 1 (low range): The comparator voltage reference module provides an internally generated voltage reference for the comparators. The following features are available: • • • • CVREF = (VR<3:0>/24) × V DD V RR = 0 (high range): CV REF = (VDD/4) + (VR<3:0> × VDD/32) Independent from Comparator operation Two 16-level voltage ranges Output clamped to VSS Ratiometric with VDD The full range of VSS to VDD cannot be realized due to the construction of the module. See Figure 8-8. The VRCON register (Register ) controls the voltage reference module shown in Figure 8-8. 8.10.1 CVREF OUTPUT VOLTAGE INDEPENDENT OPERATION 8.10.3 OUTPUT CLAMPED TO VSS The CVREF output voltage can be set to Vss with no power consumption by configuring VRCON as follows: The comparator voltage reference is independent of the comparator configuration. Setting the VREN bit of the VRCON register will enable the voltage reference. • VREN = 0 • VRR = 1 • VR<3:0> = 0000 8.10.2 This allows the comparator to detect a zero-crossing while not consuming additional CVREF module current. OUTPUT VOLTAGE SELECTION The CVREF voltage reference has 2 ranges with 16 voltage levels in each range. Range selection is controlled by the VRR bit of the VRCON register. The 16 levels are set with the VR<3:0> bits of the VRCON register. The CVREF output voltage is determined by the following equations: 8.10.4 OUTPUT RATIOMETRIC TO VDD The comparator voltage reference is VDD derived and therefore, the CVREF output changes with fluctuations in VDD. The tested absolute accuracy of the Comparator Voltage Reference can be found in Section 15.0 “Electrical Specifications”. VRCON: VOLTAGE REFERENCE CONTROL REGISTER R/W-0 U-0 R/W-0 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 VREN — VRR — VR3 VR2 VR1 VR0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 7 VREN: CVREF Enable bit 1 = CVREF circuit powered on 0 = CVREF circuit powered down, no IDD drain and CVREF = VSS. bit 6 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 5 VRR: CVREF Range Selection bit 1 = Low range 0 = High range bit 4 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 3-0 VR<3:0>: CVREF Value Selection bits (0 ≤ VR<3:0> ≤ 15) When VRR = 1: CVREF = (VR<3:0>/24) * VDD When VRR = 0: CVREF = VDD/4 + (VR<3:0>/32) * VDD © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. x = Bit is unknown DS41202F-page 63 PIC16F684 FIGURE 8-8: COMPARATOR VOLTAGE REFERENCE BLOCK DIAGRAM 16 Stages 8R R R R R VDD 8R VRR 16-1 Analog MUX VREN 15 14 CVREF to Comparator Input 2 1 0 VR<3:0>(1) VREN VR<3:0> = 0000 VRR Note 1: TABLE 8-2: Name Care should be taken to ensure VREF remains within the comparator common mode input range. See Section 15.0 “Electrical Specifications” for more detail. SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH THE COMPARATOR AND VOLTAGE REFERENCE MODULES Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Value on: POR, BOR Value on all other Resets ANS7 ANS6 ANS5 ANS4 ANS3 ANS2 ANS1 ANS0 1111 1111 1111 1111 CMCON0 C2OUT C1OUT C2INV C1INV CIS CM2 CM1 CM0 0000 0000 0000 0000 CMCON1 — — — — — — T1GSS C2SYNC ---- --10 ---- --10 INTCON GIE PEIE T0IE INTE RAIE T0IF INTF RAIF 0000 0000 0000 0000 PIE1 EEIE ADIE CCP1IE C2IE C1IE OSFIE TMR2IE TMR1IE 0000 0000 0000 0000 PIR1 EEIF ADIF CCP1IF C2IF C1IF OSFIF TMR2IF TMR1IF 0000 0000 0000 0000 PORTA — — RA5 RA4 RA3 RA2 RA1 RA0 --x0 x000 --uu uu00 PORTC — — RC5 RC4 RC3 RC2 RC1 RC0 --xx 0000 --uu uu00 TRISA — — TRISA5 TRISA4 TRISA3 TRISA2 TRISA1 TRISA0 --11 1111 --11 1111 TRISC — — TRISC5 TRISC4 TRISC3 TRISC2 TRISC1 TRISC0 --11 1111 --11 1111 VREN — VR1 VR0 0-0- 0000 0-0- 0000 ANSEL VRCON Legend: VRR — VR3 VR2 x = unknown, u = unchanged, - = unimplemented, read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used for comparator. DS41202F-page 64 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 9.0 ANALOG-TO-DIGITAL CONVERTER (ADC) MODULE The Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) allows conversion of an analog input signal to a 10-bit binary representation of that signal. This device uses analog inputs, which are multiplexed into a single sample and hold circuit. The output of the sample and hold is connected to the input of the converter. The converter generates a 10-bit binary result via successive approximation and stores the conversion result into the ADC result registers (ADRESL and ADRESH). The ADC voltage reference is software selectable to either VDD or a voltage applied to the external reference pins. The ADC can generate an interrupt upon completion of a conversion. This interrupt can be used to wake-up the device from Sleep. Figure 9-1 shows the block diagram of the ADC. FIGURE 9-1: ADC BLOCK DIAGRAM VDD VCFG = 0 VREF VCFG = 1 RA0/AN0 RA1/AN1/VREF RA2/AN2 A/D 10 GO/DONE RA4/AN3 RC0/AN4 ADFM RC1/AN5 RC2/AN6 0 = Left Justify 1 = Right Justify ADON 10 RC3/AN7 4 VSS ADRESH ADRESL CHS <3:0> © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 65 PIC16F684 9.1 9.1.4 ADC Configuration When configuring and using the ADC the following functions must be considered: • • • • • • Port configuration Channel selection ADC voltage reference selection ADC conversion clock source Interrupt control Results formatting 9.1.1 The ADC can be used to convert both analog and digital signals. When converting analog signals, the I/O pin should be configured for analog by setting the associated TRIS and ANSEL bits. See the corresponding port section for more information. Note: Analog voltages on any pin that is defined as a digital input may cause the input buffer to conduct excess current. 9.1.2 The source of the conversion clock is software selectable via the ADCS bits of the ADCON1 register. There are seven possible clock options: • • • • • • • PORT CONFIGURATION CONVERSION CLOCK FOSC/2 FOSC/4 FOSC/8 FOSC/16 FOSC/32 FOSC/64 FRC (dedicated internal oscillator) The time to complete one bit conversion is defined as TAD. One full 10-bit conversion requires 11 TAD periods as shown in Figure 9-3. For correct conversion, the appropriate TAD specification must be met. See A/D conversion requirements in Section 15.0 “Electrical Specifications” for more information. Table 9-1 gives examples of appropriate ADC clock selections. Note: CHANNEL SELECTION The CHS bits of the ADCON0 register determine which channel is connected to the sample and hold circuit. Unless using the FRC, any changes in the system clock frequency will change the ADC clock frequency, which may adversely affect the ADC result. When changing channels, a delay is required before starting the next conversion. Refer to Section 9.2 “ADC Operation” for more information. ADC VOLTAGE REFERENCE 9.1.3 The VCFG bit of the ADCON0 register provides control of the positive voltage reference. The positive voltage reference can be either VDD or an external voltage source. The negative voltage reference is always connected to the ground reference. TABLE 9-1: ADC CLOCK PERIOD (TAD) VS. DEVICE OPERATING FREQUENCIES (VDD > 3.0V) ADC Clock Period (TAD) Device Frequency (FOSC) ADC Clock Source ADCS<2:0> 20 MHz 8 MHz 4 MHz 1 MHz FOSC/2 000 100 ns(2) 250 ns(2) 500 ns(2) 2.0 μs FOSC/4 100 200 ns(2) ns(2) 1.0 μs(2) 4.0 μs FOSC/8 001 400 ns(2) 1.0 μs(2) 2.0 μs 8.0 μs(3) FOSC/16 101 800 ns(2) 2.0 μs 4.0 μs 16.0 μs(3) FOSC/32 010 1.6 μs 4.0 μs 8.0 μs(3) 32.0 μs(3) μs(3) 64.0 μs(3) 2-6 μs(1,4) 2-6 μs(1,4) FOSC/64 110 3.2 μs FRC x11 2-6 μs(1,4) Legend: Note 1: 2: 3: 4: 500 8.0 μs(3) 2-6 μs(1,4) 16.0 Shaded cells are outside of recommended range. The FRC source has a typical TAD time of 4 μs for VDD > 3.0V. These values violate the minimum required TAD time. For faster conversion times, the selection of another clock source is recommended. When the device frequency is greater than 1 MHz, the FRC clock source is only recommended if the conversion will be performed during Sleep. DS41202F-page 66 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 FIGURE 9-2: ANALOG-TO-DIGITAL CONVERSION TAD CYCLES TCY to TAD TAD1 TAD2 TAD3 TAD4 TAD5 TAD6 TAD7 TAD8 TAD9 TAD10 TAD11 b9 b8 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Conversion Starts Holding Capacitor is Disconnected from Analog Input (typically 100 ns) Set GO/DONE bit 9.1.5 ADRESH and ADRESL registers are loaded, GO bit is cleared, ADIF bit is set, Holding capacitor is connected to analog input INTERRUPTS 9.1.6 The ADC module allows for the ability to generate an interrupt upon completion of an analog-to-digital conversion. The ADC interrupt flag is the ADIF bit in the PIR1 register. The ADC interrupt enable is the ADIE bit in the PIE1 register. The ADIF bit must be cleared in software. Note: RESULT FORMATTING The 10-bit A/D conversion result can be supplied in two formats, left justified or right justified. The ADFM bit of the ADCON0 register controls the output format. Figure 9-4 shows the two output formats. The ADIF bit is set at the completion of every conversion, regardless of whether or not the ADC interrupt is enabled. This interrupt can be generated while the device is operating or while in Sleep. If the device is in Sleep, the interrupt will wake-up the device. Upon waking from Sleep, the next instruction following the SLEEP instruction is always executed. If the user is attempting to wake-up from Sleep and resume in-line code execution, the global interrupt must be disabled. If the global interrupt is enabled, execution will switch to the interrupt service routine. Please see Section 9.1.5 “Interrupts” for more information. FIGURE 9-3: 10-BIT A/D CONVERSION RESULT FORMAT ADRESH (ADFM = 0) ADRESL MSB LSB bit 7 bit 0 bit 7 10-bit A/D Result (ADFM = 1) bit 0 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ MSB bit 7 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. LSB bit 0 bit 7 bit 0 10-bit A/D Result DS41202F-page 67 PIC16F684 9.2 9.2.1 ADC Operation STARTING A CONVERSION To enable the ADC module, the ADON bit of the ADCON0 register must be set to a ‘1’. Setting the GO/DONE bit of the ADCON0 register to a ‘1’ will start the analog-to-digital conversion. Note: 9.2.2 The GO/DONE bit should not be set in the same instruction that turns on the ADC. Refer to Section 9.2.6 “A/D Conversion Procedure”. COMPLETION OF A CONVERSION When the conversion is complete, the ADC module will: • Clear the GO/DONE bit • Set the ADIF flag bit • Update the ADRESH:ADRESL registers with new conversion result 9.2.3 TERMINATING A CONVERSION If a conversion must be terminated before completion, the GO/DONE bit can be cleared in software. The ADRESH:ADRESL registers will not be updated with the partially complete analog-to-digital conversion sample. Instead, the ADRESH:ADRESL register pair will retain the value of the previous conversion. Additionally, a 2 TAD delay is required before another acquisition can be initiated. Following this delay, an input acquisition is automatically started on the selected channel. Note: 9.2.4 A device Reset forces all registers to their Reset state. Thus, the ADC module is turned off and any pending conversion is terminated. 9.2.5 The ECCP Special Event Trigger allows periodic ADC measurements without software intervention. When this trigger occurs, the GO/DONE bit is set by hardware and the Timer1 counter resets to zero. Using the Special Event Trigger does not ensure proper ADC timing. It is the user’s responsibility to ensure that the ADC timing requirements are met. See Section 11.0 “Enhanced Capture/Compare/PWM (With Auto-Shutdown and Dead Band) Module” for more information. 9.2.6 When the ADC clock source is something other than FRC, a SLEEP instruction causes the present conversion to be aborted and the ADC module is turned off, although the ADON bit remains set. DS41202F-page 68 A/D CONVERSION PROCEDURE This is an example procedure for using the ADC to perform an Analog-to-Digital conversion: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. ADC OPERATION DURING SLEEP The ADC module can operate during Sleep. This requires the ADC clock source to be set to the FRC option. When the FRC clock source is selected, the ADC waits one additional instruction before starting the conversion. This allows the SLEEP instruction to be executed, which can reduce system noise during the conversion. If the ADC interrupt is enabled, the device will wake-up from Sleep when the conversion completes. If the ADC interrupt is disabled, the ADC module is turned off after the conversion completes, although the ADON bit remains set. SPECIAL EVENT TRIGGER 7. 8. Configure Port: • Disable pin output driver (See TRIS register) • Configure pin as analog Configure the ADC module: • Select ADC conversion clock • Configure voltage reference • Select ADC input channel • Select result format • Turn on ADC module Configure ADC interrupt (optional): • Clear ADC interrupt flag • Enable ADC interrupt • Enable peripheral interrupt • Enable global interrupt(1) Wait the required acquisition time(2). Start conversion by setting the GO/DONE bit. Wait for ADC conversion to complete by one of the following: • Polling the GO/DONE bit • Waiting for the ADC interrupt (interrupts enabled) Read ADC Result Clear the ADC interrupt flag (required if interrupt is enabled). Note 1: The global interrupt can be disabled if the user is attempting to wake-up from Sleep and resume in-line code execution. 2: See Section 9.3 Requirements”. “A/D Acquisition © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 EXAMPLE 9-1: A/D CONVERSION ;This code block configures the ADC ;for polling, Vdd reference, Frc clock ;and AN0 input. ; ;Conversion start & polling for completion ; are included. ; BANKSEL ADCON1 ; MOVLW B’01110000’ ;ADC Frc clock MOVWF ADCON1 ; BANKSEL TRISA ; BSF TRISA,0 ;Set RA0 to input BANKSEL ANSEL ; BSF ANSEL,0 ;Set RA0 to analog BANKSEL ADCON0 ; MOVLW B’10000001’ ;Right justify, MOVWF ADCON0 ; Vdd Vref, AN0, On CALL SampleTime ;Acquisiton delay BSF ADCON0,GO ;Start conversion BTFSC ADCON0,GO ;Is conversion done? GOTO $-1 ;No, test again BANKSEL ADRESH ; MOVF ADRESH,W ;Read upper 2 bits MOVWF RESULTHI ;store in GPR space BANKSEL ADRESL ; MOVF ADRESL,W ;Read lower 8 bits MOVWF RESULTLO ;Store in GPR space © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 69 PIC16F684 9.2.7 ADC REGISTER DEFINITIONS The following registers are used to control the operation of the ADC. REGISTER 9-1: ADCON0: A/D CONTROL REGISTER 0 R/W-0 R/W-0 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 ADFM VCFG — CHS2 CHS1 CHS0 GO/DONE ADON bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 7 ADFM: A/D Conversion Result Format Select bit 1 = Right justified 0 = Left justified bit 6 VCFG: Voltage Reference bit 1 = VREF pin 0 = VDD bit 5 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 4-2 CHS<2:0>: Analog Channel Select bits 000 = AN0 001 = AN1 010 = AN2 011 = AN3 100 = AN4 101 = AN5 110 = AN6 111 = AN7 bit 1 GO/DONE: A/D Conversion Status bit 1 = A/D conversion cycle in progress. Setting this bit starts an A/D conversion cycle. This bit is automatically cleared by hardware when the A/D conversion has completed. 0 = A/D conversion completed/not in progress bit 0 ADON: ADC Enable bit 1 = ADC is enabled 0 = ADC is disabled and consumes no operating current REGISTER 9-2: ADCON1: A/D CONTROL REGISTER 1 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 — ADCS2 ADCS1 ADCS0 — — — — bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 7 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 6-4 ADCS<2:0>: A/D Conversion Clock Select bits 000 = FOSC/2 001 = FOSC/8 010 = FOSC/32 x11 = FRC (clock derived from a dedicated internal oscillator = 500 kHz max) 100 = FOSC/4 101 = FOSC/16 110 = FOSC/64 bit 3-0 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ DS41202F-page 70 x = Bit is unknown © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 REGISTER 9-3: ADRESH: ADC RESULT REGISTER HIGH (ADRESH) ADFM = 0 R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x ADRES9 ADRES8 ADRES7 ADRES6 ADRES5 ADRES4 ADRES3 ADRES2 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 7-0 x = Bit is unknown ADRES<9:2>: ADC Result Register bits Upper 8 bits of 10-bit conversion result REGISTER 9-4: ADRESL: ADC RESULT REGISTER LOW (ADRESL) ADFM = 0 R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x ADRES1 ADRES0 — — — — — — bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 7-6 ADRES<1:0>: ADC Result Register bits Lower 2 bits of 10-bit conversion result bit 5-0 Reserved: Do not use. REGISTER 9-5: x = Bit is unknown ADRESH: ADC RESULT REGISTER HIGH (ADRESH) ADFM = 1 R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x — — — — — — ADRES9 ADRES8 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 7-2 Reserved: Do not use. bit 1-0 ADRES<9:8>: ADC Result Register bits Upper 2 bits of 10-bit conversion result REGISTER 9-6: x = Bit is unknown ADRESL: ADC RESULT REGISTER LOW (ADRESL) ADFM = 1 R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x ADRES7 ADRES6 ADRES5 ADRES4 ADRES3 ADRES2 ADRES1 ADRES0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 7-0 x = Bit is unknown ADRES<7:0>: ADC Result Register bits Lower 8 bits of 10-bit conversion result © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 71 PIC16F684 9.3 A/D Acquisition Requirements For the ADC to meet its specified accuracy, the charge holding capacitor (CHOLD) must be allowed to fully charge to the input channel voltage level. The Analog Input model is shown in Figure 9-4. The source impedance (RS) and the internal sampling switch (RSS) impedance directly affect the time required to charge the capacitor CHOLD. The sampling switch (RSS) impedance varies over the device voltage (VDD), see Figure 9-4. The maximum recommended impedance for analog sources is 10 kΩ. As the source impedance is decreased, the acquisition time may be decreased. After the analog input channel is selected (or changed), an A/D acquisition must be done before the conversion can be started. To calculate the minimum acquisition time, Equation 9-1 may be used. This equation assumes that 1/2 LSb error is used (1024 steps for the ADC). The 1/2 LSb error is the maximum error allowed for the ADC to meet its specified resolution. EQUATION 9-1: ACQUISITION TIME EXAMPLE Temperature = 50°C and external impedance of 10k Ω 5.0V V DD Assumptions: T ACQ = Amplifier Settling Time + Hold Capacitor Charging Time + Temperature Coefficient = T AMP + T C + T COFF = 5µs + T C + [ ( Temperature - 25°C ) ( 0.05µs/°C ) ] The value for TC can be approximated with the following equations: 1 V AP PLIE D ⎛⎝ 1 – ------------⎞⎠ = V CHOLD 2047 ;[1] VCHOLD charged to within 1/2 lsb –TC ----------⎞ ⎛ RC V AP P LI ED ⎜ 1 – e ⎟ = V CHOLD ⎝ ⎠ ;[2] VCHOLD charge response to VAPPLIED – Tc ---------⎞ ⎛ 1 RC V AP P LIED ⎜ 1 – e ⎟ = V A P PLIE D ⎛⎝ 1 – ------------⎞⎠ 2047 ⎝ ⎠ ;combining [1] and [2] Solving for TC: T C = – C HOLD ( R IC + R SS + R S ) ln(1/2047) = – 10pF ( 1k Ω + 7k Ω + 10k Ω ) ln(0.0004885) = 1.37 µs Therefore: T ACQ = 5µ S + 1.37µ S + [ ( 50°C- 25°C ) ( 0.05µ S /°C ) ] = 7.67µ S Note 1: The reference voltage (VREF) has no effect on the equation, since it cancels itself out. 2: The charge holding capacitor (CHOLD) is not discharged after each conversion. 3: The maximum recommended impedance for analog sources is 10 kΩ. This is required to meet the pin leakage specification. DS41202F-page 72 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 FIGURE 9-4: ANALOG INPUT MODEL VDD ANx Rs CPIN 5 pF VA VT = 0.6V VT = 0.6V RIC ≤ 1k Sampling Switch SS Rss I LEAKAGE ± 500 nA CHOLD = 10 pF VSS/VREF- Legend: CPIN = Input Capacitance = Threshold Voltage VT I LEAKAGE = Leakage current at the pin due to various junctions RIC = Interconnect Resistance SS = Sampling Switch CHOLD = Sample/Hold Capacitance FIGURE 9-5: 6V 5V VDD 4V 3V 2V RSS 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 Sampling Switch (kΩ) ADC TRANSFER FUNCTION Full-Scale Range 3FFh 3FEh ADC Output Code 3FDh 3FCh 1 LSB ideal 3FBh Full-Scale Transition 004h 003h 002h 001h 000h Analog Input Voltage 1 LSB ideal VSS/VREF- © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. Zero-Scale Transition VDD/VREF+ DS41202F-page 73 PIC16F684 TABLE 9-2: SUMMARY OF ASSOCIATED ADC REGISTERS Value on all other Resets Value on: POR, BOR Name Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 ADCON0 ADFM VCFG — CHS2 CHS1 CHS0 GO/DONE ADON 0000 0000 0000 0000 — ADCS2 ADCS1 ADCS0 — — — — -000 ---- -000 ---- ANS7 ANS6 ANS5 ANS4 ANS3 ANS2 ANS1 ANS0 1111 1111 1111 1111 ADCON1 ANSEL ADRESH A/D Result Register High Byte xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu ADRESL A/D Result Register Low Byte xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu 0000 0000 0000 0000 INTCON GIE PEIE T0IE INTE RAIE T0IF INTF RAIF PIE1 EEIE ADIE CCPIE C2IE C1IE OSFIE TMR2IE TMR1IE 0000 0000 0000 0000 PIR1 EEIF ADIF CCPIF C2IF C1IF OSFIF TMR2IF TMR1IF 0000 0000 0000 0000 PORTA — — RA5 RA4 RA3 RA2 RA1 RA0 --x0 x000 --uu uuuu --uu uuuu PORTC — — RC5 RC4 RC3 RC2 RC1 RC0 --xx 0000 TRISA — — TRISA5 TRISA4 TRISA3 TRISA2 TRISA1 TRISA0 --11 1111 --11 1111 TRISC — — TRISC5 TRISC4 TRISC3 TRISC2 TRISC1 TRISC0 --11 1111 --11 1111 Legend: x = unknown, u = unchanged, — = unimplemented read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used for ADC module. DS41202F-page 74 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 10.0 DATA EEPROM MEMORY The EEPROM data memory is readable and writable during normal operation (full VDD range). This memory is not directly mapped in the register file space. Instead, it is indirectly addressed through the Special Function Registers. There are four SFRs used to read and write this memory: • • • • EECON1 EECON2 (not a physically implemented register) EEDAT EEADR EEDAT holds the 8-bit data for read/write, and EEADR holds the address of the EEPROM location being accessed. PIC16F684 has 256 bytes of data EEPROM with an address range from 0h to FFh. REGISTER 10-1: The EEPROM data memory allows byte read and write. A byte write automatically erases the location and writes the new data (erase before write). The EEPROM data memory is rated for high erase/write cycles. The write time is controlled by an on-chip timer. The write time will vary with voltage and temperature as well as from chip-to-chip. Please refer to AC Specifications in Section 15.0 “Electrical Specifications” for exact limits. When the data memory is code-protected, the CPU may continue to read and write the data EEPROM memory. The device programmer can no longer access the data EEPROM data and will read zeroes. EEDAT: EEPROM DATA REGISTER R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 EEDAT7 EEDAT6 EEDAT5 EEDAT4 EEDAT3 EEDAT2 EEDAT1 EEDAT0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 7-0 x = Bit is unknown EEDATn: Byte Value to Write To or Read From Data EEPROM bits REGISTER 10-2: EEADR: EEPROM ADDRESS REGISTER R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 EEADR7 EEADR6 EEADR5 EEADR4 EEADR3 EEADR2 EEADR1 EEADR0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 7-0 x = Bit is unknown EEADR: Specifies One of 256 Locations for EEPROM Read/Write Operation bits © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 75 PIC16F684 10.1 EECON1 and EECON2 Registers EECON1 is the control register with four low-order bits physically implemented. The upper four bits are non-implemented and read as ‘0’s. Control bits RD and WR initiate read and write, respectively. These bits cannot be cleared, only set in software. They are cleared in hardware at completion of the read or write operation. The inability to clear the WR bit in software prevents the accidental, premature termination of a write operation. The WREN bit, when set, will allow a write operation. On power-up, the WREN bit is clear. The WRERR bit is set when a write operation is interrupted by a MCLR Reset, or a WDT Time-out Reset during normal REGISTER 10-3: operation. In these situations, following Reset, the user can check the WRERR bit, clear it and rewrite the location. The data and address will be cleared. Therefore, the EEDAT and EEADR registers will need to be re-initialized. Interrupt flag, EEIF bit of the PIR1 register, is set when write is complete. This bit must be cleared in software. EECON2 is not a physical register. Reading EECON2 will read all ‘0’s. The EECON2 register is used exclusively in the data EEPROM write sequence. Note: The EECON1, EEDAT and EEADR registers should not be modified during a data EEPROM write (WR bit = 1). EECON1: EEPROM CONTROL REGISTER U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 R/W-x R/W-0 R/S-0 R/S-0 — — — — WRERR WREN WR RD bit 7 bit 0 Legend: S = Bit can only be set R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 7-4 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 3 WRERR: EEPROM Error Flag bit 1 = A write operation is prematurely terminated (any MCLR Reset, any WDT Reset during normal operation or BOR Reset) 0 = The write operation completed bit 2 WREN: EEPROM Write Enable bit 1 = Allows write cycles 0 = Inhibits write to the data EEPROM bit 1 WR: Write Control bit 1 = Initiates a write cycle (The bit is cleared by hardware once write is complete. The WR bit can only be set, not cleared, in software.) 0 = Write cycle to the data EEPROM is complete bit 0 RD: Read Control bit 1 = Initiates an EEPROM read (Read takes one cycle. RD is cleared in hardware. The RD bit can only be set, not cleared, in software.) 0 = Does not initiate an EEPROM read DS41202F-page 76 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 10.2 Reading the EEPROM Data Memory To read a data memory location, the user must write the address to the EEADR register and then set control bit RD of the EECON1 register, as shown in Example 10-1. The data is available, at the very next cycle, in the EEDAT register. Therefore, it can be read in the next instruction. EEDAT holds this value until another read, or until it is written to by the user (during a write operation). EXAMPLE 10-1: DATA EEPROM READ BANKSEL MOVLW MOVWF BSF MOVF EEADR ; CONFIG_ADDR ; EEADR ;Address to read EECON1,RD ;EE Read EEDAT,W ;Move data to W 10.3 Writing to the EEPROM Data Memory To write an EEPROM data location, the user must first write the address to the EEADR register and the data to the EEDAT register. Then the user must follow a specific sequence to initiate the write for each byte, as shown in Example 10-2. Required Sequence EXAMPLE 10-2: BANKSEL BSF BCF BTFSC GOTO MOVLW MOVWF MOVLW MOVWF BSF BSF DATA EEPROM WRITE EECON1 EECON1,WREN INTCON,GIE INTCON,GIE $-2 55h EECON2 AAh EECON2 EECON1,WR INTCON,GIE ; ;Enable write ;Disable INTs ;See AN576 ; ;Unlock write ; ; ; ;Start the write ;Enable INTS The write will not initiate if the above sequence is not exactly followed (write 55h to EECON2, write AAh to EECON2, then set WR bit) for each byte. We strongly recommend that interrupts be disabled during this code segment. A cycle count is executed during the required sequence. Any number that is not equal to the required cycles to execute the required sequence will prevent the data from being written into the EEPROM. After a write sequence has been initiated, clearing the WREN bit will not affect this write cycle. The WR bit will be inhibited from being set unless the WREN bit is set. At the completion of the write cycle, the WR bit is cleared in hardware and the EE Write Complete Interrupt Flag bit (EEIF) is set. The user can either enable this interrupt or poll this bit. The EEIF bit of the PIR1 register must be cleared by software. 10.4 Write Verify Depending on the application, good programming practice may dictate that the value written to the data EEPROM should be verified (see Example 10-3) to the desired value to be written. EXAMPLE 10-3: WRITE VERIFY BANKSELEEDAT MOVF EEDAT,W BSF EECON1,RD XORWF BTFSS GOTO : EEDAT,W STATUS,Z WRITE_ERR 10.4.1 ; ;EEDAT not changed ;from previous write ;YES, Read the ;value written ;Is data the same ;No, handle error ;Yes, continue USING THE DATA EEPROM The data EEPROM is a high-endurance, byte addressable array that has been optimized for the storage of frequently changing information (e.g., program variables or other data that are updated often). When variables in one section change frequently, while variables in another section do not change, it is possible to exceed the total number of write cycles to the EEPROM (specification D124) without exceeding the total number of write cycles to a single byte (specifications D120 and D120A). If this is the case, then a refresh of the array must be performed. For this reason, variables that change infrequently (such as constants, IDs, calibration, etc.) should be stored in Flash program memory. Additionally, the WREN bit in EECON1 must be set to enable write. This mechanism prevents accidental writes to data EEPROM due to errant (unexpected) code execution (i.e., lost programs). The user should keep the WREN bit clear at all times, except when updating EEPROM. The WREN bit is not cleared by hardware. © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 77 PIC16F684 10.5 Protection Against Spurious Write 10.6 There are conditions when the user may not want to write to the data EEPROM memory. To protect against spurious EEPROM writes, various mechanisms have been built in. On power-up, WREN is cleared. Also, the Power-up Timer (64 ms duration) prevents EEPROM write. The write initiate sequence and the WREN bit together help prevent an accidental write during: • Brown-out • Power Glitch • Software Malfunction TABLE 10-1: Name Data EEPROM Operation During Code-Protect Data memory can be code-protected by programming the CPD bit in the Configuration Word register (Register 12-1) to ‘0’. When the data memory is code-protected, the CPU is able to read and write data to the data EEPROM. It is recommended to code-protect the program memory when code-protecting data memory. This prevents anyone from programming zeroes over the existing code (which will execute as NOPs) to reach an added routine, programmed in unused program memory, which outputs the contents of data memory. Programming unused locations in program memory to ‘0’ will also help prevent data memory code protection from becoming breached. SUMMARY OF ASSOCIATED DATA EEPROM REGISTERS Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Value on: POR, BOR Value on all other Resets INTCON GIE PEIE T0IE INTE RAIE T0IF INTF RAIF 0000 0000 0000 0000 PIR1 EEIF ADIF CCP1IF C2IF C1IF OSFIF TMR2IF TMR1IF 0000 0000 0000 0000 EEIE ADIE CCP1IE C2IE C1IE OSFIE TMR2IE TMR1IE 0000 0000 0000 0000 EEDAT EEDAT7 EEDAT6 EEDAT5 EEDAT4 EEDAT3 EEDAT2 EEDAT1 EEDAT0 0000 0000 0000 0000 EEADR EEADR7 EEADR6 EEADR5 EEADR4 EEADR3 EEADR2 EEADR1 EEADR0 0000 0000 0000 0000 PIE1 EECON1 — — — EECON2(1) EEPROM Control Register 2 — WRERR WREN WR RD ---- x000 ---- q000 ---- ---- ---- ---- Legend: x = unknown, u = unchanged, – = unimplemented read as ‘0’, q = value depends upon condition. Shaded cells are not used by the Data EEPROM module. Note 1: EECON2 is not a physical register. DS41202F-page 78 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 11.0 ENHANCED CAPTURE/COMPARE/PWM (WITH AUTO-SHUTDOWN AND DEAD BAND) MODULE Table 11-1 shows the timer resources required by the ECCP module. TABLE 11-1: The Enhanced Capture/Compare/PWM module is a peripheral which allows the user to time and control different events. In Capture mode, the peripheral allows the timing of the duration of an event. The Compare mode allows the user to trigger an external event when a predetermined amount of time has expired. The PWM mode can generate a Pulse-Width Modulated signal of varying frequency and duty cycle. REGISTER 11-1: ECCP MODE – TIMER RESOURCES REQUIRED ECCP Mode Timer Resource Capture Timer1 Compare Timer1 PWM Timer2 CCP1CON: ENHANCED CCP1 CONTROL REGISTER R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 P1M1 P1M0 DC1B1 DC1B0 CCP1M3 CCP1M2 CCP1M1 CCP1M0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 7-6 P1M<1:0>: PWM Output Configuration bits If CCP1M<3:2> = 00, 01, 10: xx = P1A assigned as Capture/Compare input; P1B, P1C, P1D assigned as port pins If CCP1M<3:2> = 11: 00 = Single output; P1A modulated; P1B, P1C, P1D assigned as port pins 01 = Full-bridge output forward; P1D modulated; P1A active; P1B, P1C inactive 10 = Half-bridge output; P1A, P1B modulated with dead-band control; P1C, P1D assigned as port pins 11 = Full-bridge output reverse; P1B modulated; P1C active; P1A, P1D inactive bit 5-4 DC1B<1:0>: PWM Duty Cycle Least Significant bits Capture mode: Unused. Compare mode: Unused. PWM mode: These bits are the two LSbs of the PWM duty cycle. The eight MSbs are found in CCPR1L. bit 3-0 CCP1M<3:0>: ECCP Mode Select bits 0000 = Capture/Compare/PWM off (resets ECCP module) 0001 = Unused (reserved) 0010 = Compare mode, toggle output on match (CCP1IF bit is set) 0011 = Unused (reserved) 0100 = Capture mode, every falling edge 0101 = Capture mode, every rising edge 0110 = Capture mode, every 4th rising edge 0111 = Capture mode, every 16th rising edge 1000 = Compare mode, set output on match (CCP1IF bit is set) 1001 = Compare mode, clear output on match (CCP1IF bit is set) 1010 = Compare mode, generate software interrupt on match (CCP1IF bit is set, CCP1 pin is unaffected) 1011 = Compare mode, trigger special event (CCP1IF bit is set; CCP1 resets TMR1 or TMR2, and starts an A/D conversion, if the ADC module is enabled) 1100 = PWM mode; P1A, P1C active-high; P1B, P1D active-high 1101 = PWM mode; P1A, P1C active-high; P1B, P1D active-low 1110 = PWM mode; P1A, P1C active-low; P1B, P1D active-high 1111 = PWM mode; P1A, P1C active-low; P1B, P1D active-low © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 79 PIC16F684 11.1 11.1.2 Capture Mode In Capture mode, CCPR1H:CCPR1L captures the 16-bit value of the TMR1 register when an event occurs on pin CCP1. An event is defined as one of the following and is configured by the CCP1M<3:0> bits of the CCP1CON register: • • • • Every falling edge Every rising edge Every 4th rising edge Every 16th rising edge When a capture is made, the Interrupt Request Flag bit CCP1IF of the PIR1 register is set. The interrupt flag must be cleared in software. If another capture occurs before the value in the CCPR1H, CCPR1L register pair is read, the old captured value is overwritten by the new captured value (see Figure 11-1). 11.1.1 CCP1 PIN CONFIGURATION In Capture mode, the CCP1 pin should be configured as an input by setting the associated TRIS control bit. Note: If the CCP1 pin is configured as an output, a write to the port can cause a capture condition. FIGURE 11-1: Prescaler ÷ 1, 4, 16 CAPTURE MODE OPERATION BLOCK DIAGRAM CCPR1H and Edge Detect 11.1.3 SOFTWARE INTERRUPT When the Capture mode is changed, a false capture interrupt may be generated. The user should keep the CCP1IE interrupt enable bit of the PIE1 register clear to avoid false interrupts. Additionally, the user should clear the CCP1IF interrupt flag bit of the PIR1 register following any change in operating mode. 11.1.4 CCP PRESCALER There are four prescaler settings specified by the CCP1M<3:0> bits of the CCP1CON register. Whenever the CCP module is turned off, or the CCP module is not in Capture mode, the prescaler counter is cleared. Any Reset will clear the prescaler counter. Switching from one capture prescaler to another does not clear the prescaler and may generate a false interrupt. To avoid this unexpected operation, turn the module off by clearing the CCP1CON register before changing the prescaler (see Example 11-1). EXAMPLE 11-1: CLRF MOVLW CCPR1L Capture Enable TMR1H Timer1 must be running in Timer mode or Synchronized Counter mode for the CCP module to use the capture feature. In Asynchronous Counter mode, the capture operation may not work. CHANGING BETWEEN CAPTURE PRESCALERS BANKSEL CCP1CON Set Flag bit CCP1IF (PIR1 register) CCP1 pin TIMER1 MODE SELECTION MOVWF ;Set Bank bits to point ;to CCP1CON CCP1CON ;Turn CCP module off NEW_CAPT_PS ;Load the W reg with ; the new prescaler ; move value and CCP ON CCP1CON ;Load CCP1CON with this ; value TMR1L CCP1CON<3:0> System Clock (FOSC) DS41202F-page 80 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 11.2 11.2.2 Compare Mode In Compare mode, the 16-bit CCPR1 register value is constantly compared against the TMR1 register pair value. When a match occurs, the CCP module may: • • • • • Toggle the CCP1 output Set the CCP1 output Clear the CCP1 output Generate a Special Event Trigger Generate a Software Interrupt All Compare modes can generate an interrupt. FIGURE 11-2: COMPARE MODE OPERATION BLOCK DIAGRAM CCP1CON<3:0> Mode Select Q S R Output Logic Match TRIS Output Enable Comparator TMR1H TMR1L Special Event Trigger Special Event Trigger will: • Clear TMR1H and TMR1L registers. • NOT set interrupt flag bit TMR1IF of the PIR1 register. • Set the GO/DONE bit to start the ADC conversion. 11.2.1 CCP1 PIN CONFIGURATION The user must configure the CCP1 pin as an output by clearing the associated TRIS bit. Note: SOFTWARE INTERRUPT MODE When Generate Software Interrupt mode is chosen (CCP1M<3:0> = 1010), the CCP module does not assert control of the CCP1 pin (see the CCP1CON register). 11.2.4 SPECIAL EVENT TRIGGER When Special Event Trigger mode is chosen (CCP1M<3:0> = 1011), the CCP module does the following: • Resets Timer1 • Starts an ADC conversion if ADC is enabled The CCP module does not assert control of the CCP1 pin in this mode (see the CCP1CON register). Set CCP1IF Interrupt Flag (PIR1) 4 CCPR1H CCPR1L CCP1 Pin In Compare mode, Timer1 must be running in either Timer mode or Synchronized Counter mode. The compare operation may not work in Asynchronous Counter mode. 11.2.3 The action on the pin is based on the value of the CCP1M<3:0> control bits of the CCP1CON register. TIMER1 MODE SELECTION The Special Event Trigger output of the CCP occurs immediately upon a match between the TMR1H, TMR1L register pair and the CCPR1H, CCPR1L register pair. The TMR1H, TMR1L register pair is not reset until the next rising edge of the Timer1 clock. This allows the CCPR1H, CCPR1L register pair to effectively provide a 16-bit programmable period register for Timer1. Note 1: The Special Event Trigger from the CCP module does not set interrupt flag bit TMR1IF of the PIR1 register. 2: Removing the match condition by changing the contents of the CCPR1H and CCPR1L register pair, between the clock edge that generates the Special Event Trigger and the clock edge that generates the Timer1 Reset, will preclude the Reset from occurring. Clearing the CCP1CON register will force the CCP1 compare output latch to the default low level. This is not the port I/O data latch. © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 81 PIC16F684 11.3 PWM Mode The PWM mode generates a Pulse-Width Modulated signal on the CCP1 pin. The duty cycle, period and resolution are determined by the following registers: • • • • PR2 T2CON CCPR1L CCP1CON FIGURE 11-4: CCP PWM OUTPUT Period Pulse Width In Pulse-Width Modulation (PWM) mode, the CCP module produces up to a 10-bit resolution PWM output on the CCP1 pin. Since the CCP1 pin is multiplexed with the PORT data latch, the TRIS for that pin must be cleared to enable the CCP1 pin output driver. Note: The PWM output (Figure 11-4) has a time base (period) and a time that the output stays high (duty cycle). TMR2 = PR2 TMR2 = CCPR1L:CCP1CON<5:4> TMR2 = 0 Clearing the CCP1CON register will relinquish CCP1 control of the CCP1 pin. Figure 11-3 shows a simplified block diagram of PWM operation. Figure 11-4 shows a typical waveform of the PWM signal. For a step by step procedure on how to set up the CCP module for PWM operation, see Section 11.3.7 “Setup for PWM Operation”. FIGURE 11-3: SIMPLIFIED PWM BLOCK DIAGRAM CCP1CON<5:4> Duty Cycle Registers CCPR1L CCPR1H(2) (Slave) CCP1 R Comparator TMR2 (1) Q S TRIS Comparator PR2 Note 1: 2: Clear Timer2, toggle CCP1 pin and latch duty cycle The 8-bit timer TMR2 register is concatenated with the 2-bit internal system clock (FOSC), or 2 bits of the prescaler, to create the 10-bit time base. In PWM mode, CCPR1H is a read-only register. DS41202F-page 82 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 11.3.1 PWM PERIOD EQUATION 11-2: The PWM period is specified by the PR2 register of Timer2. The PWM period can be calculated using the formula of Equation 11-1. EQUATION 11-1: T OSC • (TMR2 Prescale Value) EQUATION 11-3: (TMR2 Prescale Value) DUTY CYCLE RATIO CCPR1L:CCP1CON<5:4> -) Duty Cycle Ratio = (---------------------------------------------------------------------4 ( PR2 + 1 ) When TMR2 is equal to PR2, the following three events occur on the next increment cycle: • TMR2 is cleared • The CCP1 pin is set. (Exception: If the PWM duty cycle = 0%, the pin will not be set.) • The PWM duty cycle is latched from CCPR1L into CCPR1H. 11.3.2 Pulse Width = ( CCPR1L:CCP1CON<5:4> ) • PWM PERIOD PWM Period = [ ( PR2 ) + 1 ] • 4 • T OSC • Note: PULSE WIDTH The CCPR1H register and a 2-bit internal latch are used to double buffer the PWM duty cycle. This double buffering is essential for glitchless PWM operation. The 8-bit timer TMR2 register is concatenated with either the 2-bit internal system clock (FOSC), or 2 bits of the prescaler, to create the 10-bit time base. The system clock is used if the Timer2 prescaler is set to 1:1. The Timer2 postscaler (see Section 7.1 “Timer2 Operation”) is not used in the determination of the PWM frequency. When the 10-bit time base matches the CCPR1H and 2-bit latch, then the CCP1 pin is cleared (see Figure 11-3). PWM DUTY CYCLE 11.3.3 PWM RESOLUTION The PWM duty cycle is specified by writing a 10-bit value to multiple registers: CCPR1L register and CCP1<1:0> bits of the CCP1CON register. The CCPR1L contains the eight MSbs and the CCP1<1:0> bits of the CCP1CON register contain the two LSbs. CCPR1L and CCP1<1:0> bits of the CCP1CON register can be written to at any time. The duty cycle value is not latched into CCPR1H until after the period completes (i.e., a match between PR2 and TMR2 registers occurs). While using the PWM, the CCPR1H register is read-only. The resolution determines the number of available duty cycles for a given period. For example, a 10-bit resolution will result in 1024 discrete duty cycles, whereas an 8-bit resolution will result in 256 discrete duty cycles. Equation 11-2 is used to calculate the PWM pulse width. [ 4 ( PR2 + 1 ) ]- bits Resolution = log ----------------------------------------log ( 2 ) Equation 11-3 is used to calculate the PWM duty cycle ratio. TABLE 11-2: EQUATION 11-4: Note: PWM RESOLUTION If the pulse width value is greater than the period the assigned PWM pin(s) will remain unchanged. EXAMPLE PWM FREQUENCIES AND RESOLUTIONS (FOSC = 20 MHz) PWM Frequency Timer Prescale (1, 4, 16) PR2 Value Maximum Resolution (bits) TABLE 11-3: The maximum PWM resolution is 10 bits when PR2 is 255. The resolution is a function of the PR2 register value as shown by Equation 11-4. 1.22 kHz 4.88 kHz 19.53 kHz 78.12 kHz 156.3 kHz 208.3 kHz 16 4 1 1 1 1 0xFF 0xFF 0xFF 0x3F 0x1F 0x17 10 10 10 8 7 6.6 EXAMPLE PWM FREQUENCIES AND RESOLUTIONS (FOSC = 8 MHz) PWM Frequency Timer Prescale (1, 4, 16) PR2 Value Maximum Resolution (bits) © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. 1.22 kHz 4.90 kHz 19.61 kHz 76.92 kHz 153.85 kHz 200.0 kHz 16 4 1 1 1 1 0x65 0x65 0x65 0x19 0x0C 0x09 8 8 8 6 5 5 DS41202F-page 83 PIC16F684 11.3.4 OPERATION IN SLEEP MODE In Sleep mode, the TMR2 register will not increment and the state of the module will not change. If the CCP1 pin is driving a value, it will continue to drive that value. When the device wakes up, TMR2 will continue from its previous state. 11.3.5 CHANGES IN SYSTEM CLOCK FREQUENCY The PWM frequency is derived from the system clock frequency. Any changes in the system clock frequency will result in changes to the PWM frequency. See Section 3.0 “Oscillator Module (With Fail-Safe Clock Monitor)” for additional details. 11.3.6 11.3.7 The following steps should be taken when configuring the CCP module for PWM operation: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. EFFECTS OF RESET Any Reset will force all ports to Input mode and the CCP registers to their Reset states. 6. DS41202F-page 84 SETUP FOR PWM OPERATION Disable the PWM pin (CCP1) output driver by setting the associated TRIS bit. Set the PWM period by loading the PR2 register. Configure the CCP module for the PWM mode by loading the CCP1CON register with the appropriate values. Set the PWM duty cycle by loading the CCPR1L register and CCP1 bits of the CCP1CON register. Configure and start Timer2: • Clear the TMR2IF interrupt flag bit of the PIR1 register. • Set the Timer2 prescale value by loading the T2CKPS bits of the T2CON register. • Enable Timer2 by setting the TMR2ON bit of the T2CON register. Enable PWM output after a new PWM cycle has started: • Wait until Timer2 overflows (TMR2IF bit of the PIR1 register is set). • Enable the CCP1 pin output driver by clearing the associated TRIS bit. © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 11.4 PWM (Enhanced Mode) The PWM outputs are multiplexed with I/O pins and are designated P1A, P1B, P1C and P1D. The polarity of the PWM pins is configurable and is selected by setting the CCP1M bits in the CCP1CON register appropriately. The Enhanced PWM Mode can generate a PWM signal on up to four different output pins with up to 10-bits of resolution. It can do this through four different PWM output modes: • • • • Table 11-4 shows the pin assignments for each Enhanced PWM mode. Single PWM Half-Bridge PWM Full-Bridge PWM, Forward mode Full-Bridge PWM, Reverse mode Figure 11-5 shows an example of a simplified block diagram of the Enhanced PWM module. Note: To prevent the generation of an incomplete waveform when the PWM is first enabled, the ECCP module waits until the start of a new PWM period before generating a PWM signal. To select an Enhanced PWM mode, the P1M bits of the CCP1CON register must be set appropriately. FIGURE 11-5: EXAMPLE SIMPLIFIED BLOCK DIAGRAM OF THE ENHANCED PWM MODE CCP1<1:0> CCP1M<3:0> 4 P1M<1:0> Duty Cycle Registers 2 CCPR1L CCP1/P1A CCP1/P1A TRIS CCPR1H (Slave) P1B R Comparator Output Controller Q P1B TRIS P1C P1C TMR2 (1) TRIS S P1D Comparator Clear Timer2, toggle PWM pin and latch duty cycle PR2 Note 1: P1D TRIS PWM1CON The 8-bit timer TMR2 register is concatenated with the 2-bit internal Q clock, or 2 bits of the prescaler to create the 10-bit time base. Note 1: The TRIS register value for each PWM output must be configured appropriately. 2: Clearing the CCP1CON register will relinquish ECCP control of all PWM output pins. 3: Any pin not used by an Enhanced PWM mode is available for alternate pin functions TABLE 11-4: EXAMPLE PIN ASSIGNMENTS FOR VARIOUS PWM ENHANCED MODES ECCP Mode P1M CCP1/P1A P1B P1C P1D Single 00 Half-Bridge 10 Yes No No No Yes Yes No No Full-Bridge, Forward 01 Yes Yes Yes Yes Full-Bridge, Reverse 11 Yes Yes Yes Yes © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 85 PIC16F684 FIGURE 11-6: EXAMPLE PWM (ENHANCED MODE) OUTPUT RELATIONSHIPS (ACTIVE-HIGH STATE) P1M<1:0> Signal PR2+1 Pulse Width 0 Period 00 (Single Output) P1A Modulated Delay(1) Delay(1) P1A Modulated 10 (Half-Bridge) P1B Modulated P1A Active 01 (Full-Bridge, Forward) P1B Inactive P1C Inactive P1D Modulated P1A Inactive 11 (Full-Bridge, Reverse) P1B Modulated P1C Active P1D Inactive Relationships: • Period = 4 * TOSC * (PR2 + 1) * (TMR2 Prescale Value) • Pulse Width = TOSC * (CCPR1L<7:0>:CCP1CON<5:4>) * (TMR2 Prescale Value) • Delay = 4 * TOSC * (PWM1CON<6:0>) Note 1: Dead-band delay is programmed using the PWM1CON register (Section 11.4.6 “Programmable Dead-Band Delay mode”). DS41202F-page 86 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 FIGURE 11-7: EXAMPLE ENHANCED PWM OUTPUT RELATIONSHIPS (ACTIVE-LOW STATE) Signal P1M<1:0> PR2+1 Pulse Width 0 Period 00 (Single Output) P1A Modulated P1A Modulated Delay(1) 10 (Half-Bridge) Delay(1) P1B Modulated P1A Active 01 (Full-Bridge, Forward) P1B Inactive P1C Inactive P1D Modulated P1A Inactive 11 (Full-Bridge, Reverse) P1B Modulated P1C Active P1D Inactive Relationships: • Period = 4 * TOSC * (PR2 + 1) * (TMR2 Prescale Value) • Pulse Width = TOSC * (CCPR1L<7:0>:CCP1CON<5:4>) * (TMR2 Prescale Value) • Delay = 4 * TOSC * (PWM1CON<6:0>) Note 1: Dead-band delay is programmed using the PWM1CON register (Section 11.4.6 “Programmable Dead-Band Delay mode”). © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 87 PIC16F684 11.4.1 HALF-BRIDGE MODE In Half-Bridge mode, two pins are used as outputs to drive push-pull loads. The PWM output signal is output on the CCP1/P1A pin, while the complementary PWM output signal is output on the P1B pin (see Figure 11-16). This mode can be used for half-bridge applications, as shown in Figure 11-17, or for full-bridge applications, where four power switches are being modulated with two PWM signals. In Half-Bridge mode, the programmable dead-band delay can be used to prevent shoot-through current in half-bridge power devices. The value of the PDC<6:0> bits of the PWM1CON register sets the number of instruction cycles before the output is driven active. If the value is greater than the duty cycle, the corresponding output remains inactive during the entire cycle. See Section 11.4.6 “Programmable Dead-Band Delay mode” for more details of the dead-band delay operations. Since the P1A and P1B outputs are multiplexed with the PORT data latches, the associated TRIS bits must be cleared to configure P1A and P1B as outputs. FIGURE 11-8: Period Period Pulse Width P1A(2) td td P1B(2) (1) (1) (1) td = Dead-Band Delay Note 1: 2: FIGURE 11-9: EXAMPLE OF HALF-BRIDGE PWM OUTPUT At this time, the TMR2 register is equal to the PR2 register. Output signals are shown as active-high. EXAMPLE OF HALF-BRIDGE APPLICATIONS Standard Half-Bridge Circuit (“Push-Pull”) FET Driver + P1A Load FET Driver + P1B - Half-Bridge Output Driving a Full-Bridge Circuit V+ FET Driver FET Driver P1A FET Driver Load FET Driver P1B DS41202F-page 88 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 11.4.2 FULL-BRIDGE MODE In Full-Bridge mode, all four pins are used as outputs. An example of full-bridge application is shown in Figure 11-10. In the Forward mode, pin CCP1/P1A is driven to its active state, pin P1D is modulated, while P1B and P1C will be driven to their inactive state as shown in Figure 11-11. In the Reverse mode, P1C is driven to its active state, pin P1B is modulated, while P1A and P1D will be driven to their inactive state as shown Figure 11-11. P1A, P1B, P1C and P1D outputs are multiplexed with the PORT data latches. The associated TRIS bits must be cleared to configure the P1A, P1B, P1C and P1D pins as outputs. FIGURE 11-10: EXAMPLE OF FULL-BRIDGE APPLICATION V+ FET Driver QC QA FET Driver P1A Load P1B FET Driver P1C FET Driver QD QB VP1D © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 89 PIC16F684 FIGURE 11-11: EXAMPLE OF FULL-BRIDGE PWM OUTPUT Forward Mode Period P1A (2) Pulse Width P1B(2) P1C(2) P1D(2) (1) (1) Reverse Mode Period Pulse Width P1A(2) P1B(2) P1C(2) P1D(2) (1) Note 1: 2: (1) At this time, the TMR2 register is equal to the PR2 register. Output signal is shown as active-high. DS41202F-page 90 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 11.4.2.1 Direction Change in Full-Bridge Mode In the Full-Bridge mode, the P1M1 bit in the CCP1CON register allows users to control the forward/reverse direction. When the application firmware changes this direction control bit, the module will change to the new direction on the next PWM cycle. A direction change is initiated in software by changing the P1M1 bit of the CCP1CON register. The following sequence occurs four Timer2 cycles prior to the end of the current PWM period: • The modulated outputs (P1B and P1D) are placed in their inactive state. • The associated unmodulated outputs (P1A and P1C) are switched to drive in the opposite direction. • PWM modulation resumes at the beginning of the next period. See Figure 11-12 for an illustration of this sequence. The Full-Bridge mode does not provide dead-band delay. As one output is modulated at a time, dead-band delay is generally not required. There is a situation where dead-band delay is required. This situation occurs when both of the following conditions are true: 1. 2. The direction of the PWM output changes when the duty cycle of the output is at or near 100%. The turn off time of the power switch, including the power device and driver circuit, is greater than the turn on time. Figure 11-13 shows an example of the PWM direction changing from forward to reverse, at a near 100% duty cycle. In this example, at time t1, the output P1A and P1D become inactive, while output P1C becomes active. Since the turn off time of the power devices is longer than the turn on time, a shoot-through current will flow through power devices QC and QD (see Figure 11-10) for the duration of ‘t’. The same phenomenon will occur to power devices QA and QB for PWM direction change from reverse to forward. If changing PWM direction at high duty cycle is required for an application, two possible solutions for eliminating the shoot-through current are: 1. 2. Reduce PWM duty cycle for one PWM period before changing directions. Use switch drivers that can drive the switches off faster than they can drive them on. Other options to prevent shoot-through current may exist. FIGURE 11-12: EXAMPLE OF PWM DIRECTION CHANGE Period(1) Signal Period P1A (Active-High) P1B (Active-High) Pulse Width P1C (Active-High) (2) P1D (Active-High) Pulse Width Note 1: 2: The direction bit P1M1 of the CCP1CON register is written any time during the PWM cycle. When changing directions, the P1A and P1C signals switch before the end of the current PWM cycle. The modulated P1B and P1D signals are inactive at this time. The length of this time is four Timer2 counts. © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 91 PIC16F684 FIGURE 11-13: EXAMPLE OF PWM DIRECTION CHANGE AT NEAR 100% DUTY CYCLE Forward Period t1 Reverse Period P1A P1B DC P1C P1D PW TON External Switch C TOFF External Switch D Potential Shoot-Through Current Note 1: 11.4.3 T = TOFF – TON All signals are shown as active-high. 2: TON is the turn on delay of power switch QC and its driver. 3: TOFF is the turn off delay of power switch QD and its driver. START-UP CONSIDERATIONS When any PWM mode is used, the application hardware must use the proper external pull-up and/or pull-down resistors on the PWM output pins. Note: When the microcontroller is released from Reset, all of the I/O pins are in the high-impedance state. The external circuits must keep the power switch devices in the OFF state until the microcontroller drives the I/O pins with the proper signal levels or activates the PWM output(s). The CCP1M<1:0> bits of the CCP1CON register allow the user to choose whether the PWM output signals are active-high or active-low for each pair of PWM output pins (P1A/P1C and P1B/P1D). The PWM output polarities must be selected before the PWM pin output drivers are enabled. Changing the polarity configuration while the PWM pin output drivers are enabled is not recommended since it may result in damage to the application circuits. The P1A, P1B, P1C and P1D output latches may not be in the proper states when the PWM module is initialized. Enabling the PWM pin output drivers at the same time as the Enhanced PWM modes may cause damage to the application circuit. The Enhanced PWM modes must be enabled in the proper Output mode and complete a full PWM cycle before enabling the PWM pin output drivers. The completion of a full PWM cycle is indicated by the TMR2IF bit of the PIR1 register being set as the second PWM period begins. DS41202F-page 92 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 11.4.4 ENHANCED PWM AUTO-SHUTDOWN MODE The PWM mode supports an Auto-Shutdown mode that will disable the PWM outputs when an external shutdown event occurs. Auto-Shutdown mode places the PWM output pins into a predetermined state. This mode is used to help prevent the PWM from damaging the application. The auto-shutdown sources are selected using the ECCPASx bits of the ECCPAS register. A shutdown event may be generated by: • • • • A logic ‘0’ on the INT pin Comparator 1 Comparator 2 Setting the ECCPASE bit in firmware REGISTER 11-2: A shutdown condition is indicated by the ECCPASE (Auto-Shutdown Event Status) bit of the ECCPAS register. If the bit is a ‘0’, the PWM pins are operating normally. If the bit is a ‘1’, the PWM outputs are in the shutdown state. When a shutdown event occurs, two things happen: The ECCPASE bit is set to ‘1’. The ECCPASE will remain set until cleared in firmware or an auto-restart occurs (see Section 11.4.5 “Auto-Restart Mode”). The enabled PWM pins are asynchronously placed in their shutdown states. The PWM output pins are grouped into pairs [P1A/P1C] and [P1B/P1D]. The state of each pin pair is determined by the PSSAC and PSSBD bits of the ECCPAS register. Each pin pair may be placed into one of three states: • Drive logic ‘1’ • Drive logic ‘0’ • Tri-state (high-impedance) ECCPAS: ENHANCED CAPTURE/COMPARE/PWM AUTO-SHUTDOWN CONTROL REGISTER U-0 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 ECCPASE ECCPAS2 ECCPAS1 ECCPAS0 PSSAC1 PSSAC0 PSSBD1 PSSBD0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 7 ECCPASE: ECCP Auto-Shutdown Event Status bit 1 = A shutdown event has occurred; ECCP outputs are in shutdown state 0 = ECCP outputs are operating bit 6-4 ECCPAS<2:0>: ECCP Auto-shutdown Source Select bits 000 = Auto-Shutdown is disabled 001 = Comparator 1 output change 010 = Comparator 2 output change 011 = Either Comparator 1 or 2 change 100 = VIL on INT pin 101 = VIL on INT pin or Comparator 1 change 110 = VIL on INT pin or Comparator 2 change 111 = VIL on INT pin or Comparator 1 or 2 change bit 3-2 PSSACn: Pins P1A and P1C Shutdown State Control bits 00 = Drive pins P1A and P1C to ‘0’ 01 = Drive pins P1A and P1C to ‘1’ 1x = Pins P1A and P1C tri-state bit 1-0 PSSBDn: Pins P1B and P1D Shutdown State Control bits 00 = Drive pins P1B and P1D to ‘0’ 01 = Drive pins P1B and P1D to ‘1’ 1x = Pins P1B and P1D tri-state © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 93 PIC16F684 Note 1: The auto-shutdown condition is a level-based signal, not an edge-based signal. As long as the level is present, the auto-shutdown will persist. 2: Writing to the ECCPASE bit is disabled while an auto-shutdown condition persists. 3: Once the auto-shutdown condition has been removed and the PWM restarted (either through firmware or auto-restart) the PWM signal will always restart at the beginning of the next PWM period. FIGURE 11-14: PWM AUTO-SHUTDOWN WITH FIRMWARE RESTART (PRSEN = 0) PWM Period Shutdown Event ECCPASE bit PWM Activity Normal PWM ECCPASE Cleared by Shutdown Shutdown Firmware PWM Event Occurs Event Clears Resumes Start of PWM Period 11.4.5 AUTO-RESTART MODE The Enhanced PWM can be configured to automatically restart the PWM signal once the auto-shutdown condition has been removed. Auto-restart is enabled by setting the PRSEN bit in the PWM1CON register. If auto-restart is enabled, the ECCPASE bit will remain set as long as the auto-shutdown condition is active. When the auto-shutdown condition is removed, the ECCPASE bit will be cleared via hardware and normal operation will resume. FIGURE 11-15: PWM AUTO-SHUTDOWN WITH AUTO-RESTART ENABLED (PRSEN = 1) PWM Period Shutdown Event ECCPASE bit PWM Activity Normal PWM Start of PWM Period DS41202F-page 94 Shutdown Shutdown Event Occurs Event Clears PWM Resumes © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 11.4.6 PROGRAMMABLE DEAD-BAND DELAY MODE FIGURE 11-16: In half-bridge applications where all power switches are modulated at the PWM frequency, the power switches normally require more time to turn off than to turn on. If both the upper and lower power switches are switched at the same time (one turned on, and the other turned off), both switches may be on for a short period of time until one switch completely turns off. During this brief interval, a very high current (shoot-through current) will flow through both power switches, shorting the bridge supply. To avoid this potentially destructive shoot-through current from flowing during switching, turning on either of the power switches is normally delayed to allow the other switch to completely turn off. In Half-Bridge mode, a digitally programmable dead-band delay is available to avoid shoot-through current from destroying the bridge power switches. The delay occurs at the signal transition from the non-active state to the active state. See Section FIGURE 11-17: “Example of Half-Bridge Applications” for illustration. The lower seven bits of the associated PWM1CON register (Register 11-3) sets the delay period in terms of microcontroller instruction cycles (TCY or 4 TOSC). FIGURE 11-17: EXAMPLE OF HALF-BRIDGE PWM OUTPUT Period Period Pulse Width P1A(2) td td P1B(2) (1) (1) (1) td = Dead-Band Delay Note 1: 2: At this time, the TMR2 register is equal to the PR2 register. Output signals are shown as active-high. EXAMPLE OF HALF-BRIDGE APPLICATIONS V+ Standard Half-Bridge Circuit (“Push-Pull”) FET Driver + V - P1A Load FET Driver + V - P1B V- © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 95 PIC16F684 REGISTER 11-3: PWM1CON: ENHANCED PWM CONTROL REGISTER R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 PRSEN PDC6 PDC5 PDC4 PDC3 PDC2 PDC1 PDC0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 7 PRSEN: PWM Restart Enable bit 1 = Upon auto-shutdown, the ECCPASE bit clears automatically once the shutdown event goes away; the PWM restarts automatically 0 = Upon auto-shutdown, ECCPASE must be cleared in software to restart the PWM bit 6-0 PDC<6:0>: PWM Delay Count bits PDCn = Number of FOSC/4 (4 * TOSC) cycles between the scheduled time when a PWM signal should transition active and the actual time it transitions active Note 1: Bit resets to ‘0’ with Two-Speed Start-up and LP, XT or HS selected as the Oscillator mode or Fail-Safe mode is enabled. TABLE 11-5: Name SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH CAPTURE, COMPARE AND PWM Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Value on: POR, BOR Value on all other Resets CCPR1L Capture/Compare/PWM Register 1 Low Byte xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu CCPR1H Capture/Compare/PWM Register 1 High Byte xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu CCP1CON P1M1 P1M0 DC1B1 DC1B0 CCP1M3 CMCON0 C2OUT C1OUT C2INV C1INV CIS CM2 CM1 CMCON1 — — — — — — T1GSS C2SYNC ---- --10 ---- --10 PSSAC1 PSSAC0 PSSBD1 PSSBD0 0000 0000 0000 0000 ECCPAS ECCPASE ECCPAS2 ECCPAS1 ECCPAS0 CCP1M2 CCP1M1 CCP1M0 0000 0000 0000 0000 CM0 0000 0000 0000 0000 INTCON GIE PEIE T0IE INTE RAIE T0IF INTF RAIF 0000 0000 0000 0000 PIE1 EEIE ADIE CCP1IE C2IE C1IE OSFIE TMR2IE TMR1IE 0000 0000 0000 0000 PIR1 EEIF ADIF CCP1IF C2IF C1IF OSFIF TMR2IF TMR1IF 0000 0000 0000 0000 PDC4 PDC3 PDC2 PDC1 PDC0 PR2 Timer2 Module Period Register PWM1CON PRSEN T1CON T1GINV T2CON — PDC6 PDC5 1111 1111 1111 1111 TMR1GE T1CKPS1 T1CKPS0 T1OSCEN T1SYNC 0000 0000 0000 0000 TMR1CS TMR1ON 0000 0000 uuuu uuuu TOUTPS3 TOUTPS2 TOUTPS1 TOUTPS0 TMR2ON T2CKPS1 T2CKPS0 -000 0000 -000 0000 TMR1L Holding Register for the Least Significant Byte of the 16-bit TMR1 Register xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu TMR1H Holding Register for the Most Significant Byte of the 16-bit TMR1 Register xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu TMR2 Timer2 Module Register 0000 0000 0000 0000 TRISA — — TRISA5 TRISA4 TRISA3 TRISA2 TRISA1 TRISA0 --11 1111 --11 1111 TRISC — — TRISC5 TRISC4 TRISC3 TRISC2 TRISC1 TRISC0 --11 1111 --11 1111 Legend: - = Unimplemented locations, read as ‘0’, u = unchanged, x = unknown. Shaded cells are not used by the Capture, Compare and PWM. DS41202F-page 96 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 12.0 SPECIAL FEATURES OF THE CPU The PIC16F684 has a host of features intended to maximize system reliability, minimize cost through elimination of external components, provide power saving features and offer code protection. These features are: • Reset - Power-on Reset (POR) - Power-up Timer (PWRT) - Oscillator Start-up Timer (OST) - Brown-out Reset (BOR) • Interrupts • Watchdog Timer (WDT) • Oscillator selection • Sleep • Code protection • ID Locations • In-Circuit Serial Programming 12.1 Configuration Bits The Configuration bits can be programmed (read as ‘0’), or left unprogrammed (read as ‘1’) to select various device configurations as shown in Register 12-1. These bits are mapped in program memory location 2007h. Note: Address 2007h is beyond the user program memory space. It belongs to the special configuration memory space (2000h-3FFFh), which can be accessed only during programming. See “PIC12F6XX/16F6XX Memory Programming Specification” (DS41204) for more information. The PIC16F684 has two timers that offer necessary delays on power-up. One is the Oscillator Start-up Timer (OST), intended to keep the chip in Reset until the crystal oscillator is stable. The other is the Power-up Timer (PWRT), which provides a fixed delay of 64 ms (nominal) on power-up only, designed to keep the part in Reset while the power supply stabilizes. There is also circuitry to reset the device if a brown-out occurs, which can use the Power-up Timer to provide at least a 64 ms Reset. With these three functions-on-chip, most applications need no external Reset circuitry. The Sleep mode is designed to offer a very low-current Power-Down mode. The user can wake-up from Sleep through: • External Reset • Watchdog Timer Wake-up • An interrupt Several oscillator options are also made available to allow the part to fit the application. The INTOSC option saves system cost while the LP crystal option saves power. A set of configuration bits are used to select various options (see Register 12-1). © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 97 PIC16F684 REGISTER 12-1: — CONFIG: CONFIGURATION WORD REGISTER — — — FCMEN IESO BOREN1 BOREN0 bit 15 bit 8 CPD CP MCLRE PWRTE WDTE FOSC2 FOSC1 FOSC0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit P = Programmable’ U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-12 Unimplemented: Read as ‘1’ bit 11 FCMEN: Fail-Safe Clock Monitor Enabled bit 1 = Fail-Safe Clock Monitor is enabled 0 = Fail-Safe Clock Monitor is disabled bit 10 IESO: Internal External Switchover bit 1 = Internal External Switchover mode is enabled 0 = Internal External Switchover mode is disabled bit 9-8 BOREN<1:0>: Brown-out Reset Selection bits(1) 11 = BOR enabled 10 = BOR enabled during operation and disabled in Sleep 01 = BOR controlled by SBOREN bit of the PCON register 00 = BOR disabled bit 7 CPD: Data Code Protection bit(2) 1 = Data memory code protection is disabled 0 = Data memory code protection is enabled bit 6 CP: Code Protection bit(3) 1 = Program memory code protection is disabled 0 = Program memory code protection is enabled bit 5 MCLRE: RA3/MCLR pin function select bit(4) 1 = RA3/MCLR pin function is MCLR 0 = RA3/MCLR pin function is digital input, MCLR internally tied to VDD bit 4 PWRTE: Power-up Timer Enable bit 1 = PWRT disabled 0 = PWRT enabled bit 3 WDTE: Watchdog Timer Enable bit 1 = WDT enabled 0 = WDT disabled and can be enabled by SWDTEN bit of the WDTCON register bit 2-0 FOSC<2:0>: Oscillator Selection bits 111 = RC oscillator: CLKOUT function on RA4/OSC2/CLKOUT pin, RC on RA5/OSC1/CLKIN 110 = RCIO oscillator: I/O function on RA4/OSC2/CLKOUT pin, RC on RA5/OSC1/CLKIN 101 = INTOSC oscillator: CLKOUT function on RA4/OSC2/CLKOUT pin, I/O function on RA5/OSC1/CLKIN 100 = INTOSCIO oscillator: I/O function on RA4/OSC2/CLKOUT pin, I/O function on RA5/OSC1/CLKIN 011 = EC: I/O function on RA4/OSC2/CLKOUT pin, CLKIN on RA5/OSC1/CLKIN 010 = HS oscillator: High-speed crystal/resonator on RA4/OSC2/CLKOUT and RA5/OSC1/CLKIN 001 = XT oscillator: Crystal/resonator on RA4/OSC2/CLKOUT and RA5/OSC1/CLKIN 000 = LP oscillator: Low-power crystal on RA4/OSC2/CLKOUT and RA5/OSC1/CLKIN Note 1: 2: 3: 4: Enabling Brown-out Reset does not automatically enable Power-up Timer. The entire data EEPROM will be erased when the code protection is turned off. The entire program memory will be erased when the code protection is turned off. When MCLR is asserted in INTOSC or RC mode, the internal clock oscillator is disabled. DS41202F-page 98 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 12.2 Calibration Bits Brown-out Reset (BOR), Power-on Reset (POR) and 8 MHz internal oscillator (HFINTOSC) are factory calibrated. These calibration values are stored in fuses located in the Calibration Word (2009h). The Calibration Word is not erased when using the specified bulk erase sequence in the “PIC12F6XX/16F6XX Memory Programming Specification” (DS41244) and thus, does not require reprogramming. 12.3 Reset The PIC16F684 differentiates between various kinds of Reset: a) b) c) d) e) f) Power-on Reset (POR) WDT Reset during normal operation WDT Reset during Sleep MCLR Reset during normal operation MCLR Reset during Sleep Brown-out Reset (BOR) FIGURE 12-1: Some registers are not affected in any Reset condition; their status is unknown on POR and unchanged in any other Reset. Most other registers are reset to a “Reset state” on: • • • • • Power-on Reset MCLR Reset MCLR Reset during Sleep WDT Reset Brown-out Reset (BOR) WDT wake-up does not cause register resets in the same manner as a WDT Reset since wake-up is viewed as the resumption of normal operation. TO and PD bits are set or cleared differently in different Reset situations, as indicated in Table 12-2. Software can use these bits to determine the nature of the Reset. See Table 12-4 for a full description of Reset states of all registers. A simplified block diagram of the On-Chip Reset Circuit is shown in Figure 12-1. The MCLR Reset path has a noise filter to detect and ignore small pulses. See Section 15.0 “Electrical Specifications” for pulse-width specifications. SIMPLIFIED BLOCK DIAGRAM OF ON-CHIP RESET CIRCUIT External Reset MCLR/VPP pin SLEEP WDT Module WDT Time-out Reset VDD Rise Detect Power-on Reset VDD Brown-out(1) Reset BOREN SBOREN S OST/PWRT OST Chip_Reset 10-bit Ripple Counter R Q OSC1/ CLKI pin PWRT LFINTOSC 11-bit Ripple Counter Enable PWRT Enable OST Note 1: Refer to the Configuration Word register (Register 12-1). © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 99 PIC16F684 12.3.1 POWER-ON RESET (POR) The on-chip POR circuit holds the chip in Reset until VDD has reached a high enough level for proper operation. To take advantage of the POR, simply connect the MCLR pin through a resistor to VDD. This will eliminate external RC components usually needed to create Power-on Reset. A maximum rise time for VDD is required. See Section 15.0 “Electrical Specifications” for details. If the BOR is enabled, the maximum rise time specification does not apply. The BOR circuitry will keep the device in Reset until VDD reaches VBOR (see Section 12.3.4 “Brown-Out Reset (BOR)”). Note: For additional information, refer to Application Note AN607, “Power-up Trouble Shooting” (DS00607). MCLR PIC16F684 has a noise filter in the MCLR Reset path. The filter will detect and ignore small pulses. It should be noted that a WDT Reset does not drive MCLR pin low. Voltages applied to the MCLR pin that exceed its specification can result in both MCLR Resets and excessive current beyond the device specification during the ESD event. For this reason, Microchip recommends that the MCLR pin no longer be tied directly to VDD. The use of an RC network, as shown in Figure 12-2, is suggested. An internal MCLR option is enabled by clearing the MCLRE bit in the Configuration Word register. When MCLRE = 0, the Reset signal to the chip is generated internally. When the MCLRE = 1, the RA3/MCLR pin becomes an external Reset input. In this mode, the RA3/MCLR pin has a weak pull-up to VDD. DS41202F-page 100 RECOMMENDED MCLR CIRCUIT VDD R1 1 kΩ (or greater) PIC® MCU R2 MCLR SW1 (optional) 100 Ω (needed with capacitor) C1 0.1 μF (optional, not critical) The POR circuit does not produce an internal Reset when VDD declines. To re-enable the POR, VDD must reach Vss for a minimum of 100 μs. When the device starts normal operation (exits the Reset condition), device operating parameters (i.e., voltage, frequency, temperature, etc.) must be met to ensure proper operation. If these conditions are not met, the device must be held in Reset until the operating conditions are met. 12.3.2 FIGURE 12-2: 12.3.3 POWER-UP TIMER (PWRT) The Power-up Timer provides a fixed 64 ms (nominal) time-out on power-up only, from POR or Brown-out Reset. The Power-up Timer operates from the 31 kHz LFINTOSC oscillator. For more information, see Section 3.5 “Internal Clock Modes”. The chip is kept in Reset as long as PWRT is active. The PWRT delay allows the VDD to rise to an acceptable level. A Configuration bit, PWRTE, can disable (if set) or enable (if cleared or programmed) the Power-up Timer. The Power-up Timer should be enabled when Brown-out Reset is enabled, although it is not required. The Power-up Timer delay will varies from chip-to-chip due to: • VDD variation • Temperature variation • Process variation See DC parameters for details “Electrical Specifications”). Note: (Section 15.0 Voltage spikes below VSS at the MCLR pin, inducing currents greater than 80 mA, may cause latch-up. Thus, a series resistor of 50-100 Ω should be used when applying a “low” level to the MCLR pin, rather than pulling this pin directly to VSS. © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 12.3.4 BROWN-OUT RESET (BOR) If VDD drops below VBOR while the Power-up Timer is running, the chip will go back into a Brown-out Reset and the Power-up Timer will be re-initialized. Once VDD rises above VBOR, the Power-up Timer will execute a 64 ms Reset. The BOREN0 and BOREN1 bits in the Configuration Word register select one of four BOR modes. Two modes have been added to allow software or hardware control of the BOR enable. When BOREN<1:0> = 01, the SBOREN bit of the PCON register enables/disables the BOR, allowing it to be controlled in software. By selecting BOREN<1:0> = 10, the BOR is automatically disabled in Sleep to conserve power and enabled on wake-up. In this mode, the SBOREN bit is disabled. See Register 12-1 for the Configuration Word definition. 12.3.5 The PIC16F684 stores the BOR calibration values in fuses located in the Calibration Word register (2008h). The Calibration Word register is not erased when using the specified bulk erase sequence in the “PIC12F6XX/16F6XX Memory Programming Specification” (DS41204) and thus, does not require reprogramming. A brown-out occurs when VDD falls below VBOR for greater than parameter TBOR (see Section 15.0 “Electrical Specifications”). The brown-out condition will reset the device. This will occur regardless of VDD slew rate. A Brown-out Reset may not occur if VDD falls below VBOR for less than parameter TBOR. Note: On any Reset (Power-on, Brown-out Reset, Watchdog Timer, etc.), the chip will remain in Reset until VDD rises above VBOR (see Figure 12-3). If enabled, the Power-up Timer will be invoked by the Reset and keep the chip in Reset an additional 64 ms. Note: BOR CALIBRATION Address 2008h is beyond the user program memory space. It belongs to the special configuration memory space (2000h-3FFFh), which can be accessed only during programming. See “PIC12F6XX/16F6XX Memory Programming Specification” (DS41204) for more information. The Power-up Timer is enabled by the PWRTE bit in the Configuration Word register. FIGURE 12-3: BROWN-OUT SITUATIONS VDD Internal Reset VBOR 64 ms(1) VDD Internal Reset VBOR < 64 ms 64 ms(1) VDD Internal Reset Note 1: VBOR 64 ms(1) 64 ms delay only if PWRTE bit is programmed to ‘0’. © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 101 PIC16F684 12.3.6 TIME-OUT SEQUENCE 12.3.7 On power-up, the time-out sequence is as follows: The Power Control register PCON (address 8Eh) has two Status bits to indicate what type of Reset occurred last. • PWRT time-out is invoked after POR has expired. • OST is activated after the PWRT time-out has expired. Bit 0 is BOR (Brown-out). BOR is unknown on Power-on Reset. It must then be set by the user and checked on subsequent Resets to see if BOR = 0, indicating that a Brown-out has occurred. The BOR Status bit is a “don’t care” and is not necessarily predictable if the brown-out circuit is disabled (BOREN<1:0> = 00 in the Configuration Word register). The total time-out will vary based on oscillator configuration and PWRTE bit status. For example, in EC mode with PWRTE bit erased (PWRT disabled), there will be no time-out at all. Figure 12-4, Figure 12-5 and Figure 12-6 depict time-out sequences. The device can execute code from the INTOSC while OST is active by enabling Two-Speed Start-up or Fail-Safe Monitor (see Section 3.7.2 “Two-speed Start-up Sequence” and Section 3.8 “Fail-Safe Clock Monitor”). Bit 1 is POR (Power-on Reset). It is a ‘0’ on Power-on Reset and unaffected otherwise. The user must write a ‘1’ to this bit following a Power-on Reset. On a subsequent Reset, if POR is ‘0’, it will indicate that a Power-on Reset has occurred (i.e., VDD may have gone too low). Since the time-outs occur from the POR pulse, if MCLR is kept low long enough, the time-outs will expire. Then, bringing MCLR high will begin execution immediately (see Figure 12-5). This is useful for testing purposes or to synchronize more than one PIC16F684 device operating in parallel. For more information, see Section 4.2.4 “Ultra Low-Power Wake-up” and Section 12.3.4 “Brown-Out Reset (BOR)”. Table 12-5 shows the Reset conditions for some special registers, while Table 12-4 shows the Reset conditions for all the registers. TABLE 12-1: POWER CONTROL (PCON) REGISTER TIME-OUT IN VARIOUS SITUATIONS Power-up Brown-out Reset PWRTE = 0 PWRTE = 1 PWRTE = 0 PWRTE = 1 Wake-up from Sleep TPWRT + 1024 • TOSC 1024 • TOSC TPWRT + 1024 • TOSC 1024 • TOSC 1024 • TOSC TPWRT — TPWRT — — Oscillator Configuration XT, HS, LP RC, EC, INTOSC TABLE 12-2: STATUS/PCON BITS AND THEIR SIGNIFICANCE POR BOR TO PD Condition 0 x 1 1 Power-on Reset u 0 1 1 Brown-out Reset u u 0 u WDT Reset u u 0 0 WDT Wake-up u u u u MCLR Reset during normal operation u u 1 0 MCLR Reset during Sleep Legend: u = unchanged, x = unknown TABLE 12-3: Name PCON STATUS SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH BROWN-OUT RESET Bit 7 Value on all other Resets(1) Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Value on: POR, BOR SBOREN — — POR BOR --01 --qq --0u --uu TO PD Z DC C 0001 1xxx 000q quuu Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 — — ULPWUE IRP RP1 RP0 Legend: u = unchanged, x = unknown, – = unimplemented bit, reads as ‘0’, q = value depends on condition. Shaded cells are not used by BOR. Note 1: Other (non Power-up) Resets include MCLR Reset and Watchdog Timer Reset during normal operation. DS41202F-page 102 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 FIGURE 12-4: TIME-OUT SEQUENCE ON POWER-UP (DELAYED MCLR): CASE 1 VDD MCLR Internal POR TPWRT PWRT Time-out TOST OST Time-out Internal Reset TIME-OUT SEQUENCE ON POWER-UP (DELAYED MCLR): CASE 2 FIGURE 12-5: VDD MCLR Internal POR TPWRT PWRT Time-out TOST OST Time-out Internal Reset FIGURE 12-6: TIME-OUT SEQUENCE ON POWER-UP (MCLR WITH VDD) VDD MCLR Internal POR TPWRT PWRT Time-out TOST OST Time-out Internal Reset © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 103 PIC16F684 TABLE 12-4: Register INITIALIZATION CONDITION FOR REGISTERS Address Power-on Reset W INDF TMR0 MCLR Reset WDT Reset Brown-out Reset(1) Wake-up from Sleep through Interrupt Wake-up from Sleep through WDT Time-out — xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu 00h/80h xxxx xxxx xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu 01h xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu PCL 02h/82h 0000 0000 0000 0000 PC + 1(3) STATUS 03h/83h 0001 1xxx 000q quuu(4) uuuq quuu(4) FSR 04h/84h xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu (6) PORTA 05h --x0 x000 --u0 u000 --uu uuuu PORTC(6) 07h --xx 0000 --uu 0000 --uu uuuu PCLATH 0Ah/8Ah ---0 0000 ---0 0000 ---u uuuu INTCON 0Bh/8Bh 0000 0000 0000 0000 uuuu uuuu(2) PIR1 0Ch 0000 0000 0000 0000 uuuu uuuu(2) TMR1L 0Eh xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu TMR1H 0Fh xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu T1CON 10h 0000 0000 uuuu uuuu -uuu uuuu TMR2 11h 0000 0000 0000 0000 uuuu uuuu T2CON 12h -000 0000 -000 0000 -uuu uuuu CCPR1L 13h xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu CCPR1H 14h xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu CCP1CON 15h 0000 0000 0000 0000 uuuu uuuu PWM1CON 16h 0000 0000 0000 0000 uuuu uuuu ECCPAS 17h 0000 0000 0000 0000 uuuu uuuu WDTCON 18h ---0 1000 ---0 1000 ---u uuuu CMCON0 19h 0000 0000 0000 0000 uuuu uuuu CMCON1 1Ah ---- --10 ---- --10 ---- --uu ADRESH 1Eh xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu ADCON0 1Fh 00-0 0000 00-0 0000 uu-u uuuu OPTION_REG 81h 1111 1111 1111 1111 uuuu uuuu TRISA 85h --11 1111 --11 1111 --uu uuuu TRISC 87h --11 1111 --11 1111 --uu uuuu PIE1 8Ch 0000 0000 0000 0000 uuuu uuuu (1, 5) PCON 8Eh --01 --0x --0u --uq --uu --uu OSCCON 8Fh -110 x000 -110 q000 -uuu uuuu Legend: Note 1: 2: 3: 4: 5: 6: u = unchanged, x = unknown, – = unimplemented bit, reads as ‘0’, q = value depends on condition. If VDD goes too low, Power-on Reset will be activated and registers will be affected differently. One or more bits in INTCON and/or PIR1 will be affected (to cause wake-up). When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and the GIE bit is set, the PC is loaded with the interrupt vector (0004h). See Table 12-5 for Reset value for specific condition. If Reset was due to brown-out, then bit 0 = 0. All other Resets will cause bit 0 = u. Port pins with analog functions controlled by the ANSEL register will read ‘0’ immediately after a Reset even though the data latches are either undefined (POR) or unchanged (other Resets). DS41202F-page 104 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 TABLE 12-4: INITIALIZATION CONDITION FOR REGISTERS (CONTINUED) MCLR Reset WDT Reset (Continued) Brown-out Reset(1) Wake-up from Sleep through Interrupt Wake-up from Sleep through WDT Time-out (Continued) Address Power-on Reset OSCTUNE 90h ---0 0000 ---u uuuu ---u uuuu ANSEL 91h 1111 1111 1111 1111 uuuu uuuu PR2 92h 1111 1111 1111 1111 1111 1111 WPUA 95h --11 -111 --11 -111 uuuu uuuu IOCA 96h --00 0000 --00 0000 --uu uuuu VRCON 99h 0-0- 0000 0-0- 0000 u-u- uuuu EEDAT 9Ah 0000 0000 0000 0000 uuuu uuuu EEADR 9Bh 0000 0000 0000 0000 uuuu uuuu EECON1 9Ch ---- x000 ---- q000 ---- uuuu EECON2 9Dh ---- ---- ---- ---- ---- ---- ADRESL 9Eh xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu ADCON1 9Fh -000 ---- -000 ---- -uuu ---- Register Legend: Note 1: 2: 3: 4: 5: 6: u = unchanged, x = unknown, – = unimplemented bit, reads as ‘0’, q = value depends on condition. If VDD goes too low, Power-on Reset will be activated and registers will be affected differently. One or more bits in INTCON and/or PIR1 will be affected (to cause wake-up). When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and the GIE bit is set, the PC is loaded with the interrupt vector (0004h). See Table 12-5 for Reset value for specific condition. If Reset was due to brown-out, then bit 0 = 0. All other Resets will cause bit 0 = u. Port pins with analog functions controlled by the ANSEL register will read ‘0’ immediately after a Reset even though the data latches are either undefined (POR) or unchanged (other Resets). TABLE 12-5: INITIALIZATION CONDITION FOR SPECIAL REGISTERS Program Counter Status Register PCON Register Power-on Reset 000h 0001 1xxx --01 --0x MCLR Reset during normal operation 000h 000u uuuu --0u --uu MCLR Reset during Sleep 000h 0001 0uuu --0u --uu 000h 0000 uuuu --0u --uu PC + 1 uuu0 0uuu --uu --uu Condition WDT Reset WDT Wake-up Brown-out Reset Interrupt Wake-up from Sleep 000h 0001 1uuu --01 --u0 PC + 1(1) uuu1 0uuu --uu --uu Legend: u = unchanged, x = unknown, – = unimplemented bit, reads as ‘0’. Note 1: When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and Global Interrupt Enable bit, GIE, is set, the PC is loaded with the interrupt vector (0004h) after execution of PC + 1. © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 105 PIC16F684 12.4 Interrupts The PIC16F684 has 11 sources of interrupt: • • • • • • • • • • External Interrupt RA2/INT Timer0 Overflow Interrupt PORTA Change Interrupts 2 Comparator Interrupts A/D Interrupt Timer1 Overflow Interrupt Timer2 Match Interrupt EEPROM Data Write Interrupt Fail-Safe Clock Monitor Interrupt Enhanced CCP Interrupt For external interrupt events, such as the INT pin or PORTA change interrupt, the interrupt latency will be three or four instruction cycles. The exact latency depends upon when the interrupt event occurs (see Figure 12-8). The latency is the same for one or two-cycle instructions. Once in the Interrupt Service Routine, the source(s) of the interrupt can be determined by polling the interrupt flag bits. The interrupt flag bit(s) must be cleared in software before re-enabling interrupts to avoid multiple interrupt requests. Note 1: Individual interrupt flag bits are set, regardless of the status of their corresponding mask bit or the GIE bit. 2: When an instruction that clears the GIE bit is executed, any interrupts that were pending for execution in the next cycle are ignored. The interrupts, which were ignored, are still pending to be serviced when the GIE bit is set again. The Interrupt Control register (INTCON) and Peripheral Interrupt Request Register 1 (PIR1) record individual interrupt requests in flag bits. The INTCON register also has individual and global interrupt enable bits. The Global Interrupt Enable bit, GIE of the INTCON register, enables (if set) all unmasked interrupts, or disables (if cleared) all interrupts. Individual interrupts can be disabled through their corresponding enable bits in the INTCON register and PIE1 register. GIE is cleared on Reset. When an interrupt is serviced, the following actions occur automatically: • The GIE is cleared to disable any further interrupt. • The return address is pushed onto the stack. • The PC is loaded with 0004h. The Return from Interrupt instruction, RETFIE, exits the interrupt routine, as well as sets the GIE bit, which re-enables unmasked interrupts. The following interrupt flags are contained in the INTCON register: • INT Pin Interrupt • PORTA Change Interrupt • Timer0 Overflow Interrupt The peripheral interrupt flags are contained in the PIR1 register. The corresponding interrupt enable bit is contained in the PIE1 register. The following interrupt flags are contained in the PIR1 register: • • • • • • • For additional information on Timer1, Timer2, comparators, ADC, data EEPROM or Enhanced CCP modules, refer to the respective peripheral section. 12.4.1 RA2/INT INTERRUPT The external interrupt on the RA2/INT pin is edge-triggered; either on the rising edge if the INTEDG bit of the OPTION register is set, or the falling edge, if the INTEDG bit is clear. When a valid edge appears on the RA2/INT pin, the INTF bit of the INTCON register is set. This interrupt can be disabled by clearing the INTE control bit of the INTCON register. The INTF bit must be cleared by software in the Interrupt Service Routine before re-enabling this interrupt. The RA2/INT interrupt can wake-up the processor from Sleep, if the INTE bit was set prior to going into Sleep. See Section 12.7 “Power-Down Mode (Sleep)” for details on Sleep and Figure 12-10 for timing of wake-up from Sleep through RA2/INT interrupt. Note: The ANSEL and CMCON0 registers must be initialized to configure an analog channel as a digital input. Pins configured as analog inputs will read ‘0’ and cannot generate an interrupt. EEPROM Data Write Interrupt A/D Interrupt 2 Comparator Interrupts Timer1 Overflow Interrupt Timer2 Match Interrupt Fail-Safe Clock Monitor Interrupt Enhanced CCP Interrupt DS41202F-page 106 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 12.4.2 TIMER0 INTERRUPT 12.4.3 An overflow (FFh → 00h) in the TMR0 register will set the T0IF bit of the INTCON register. The interrupt can be enabled/disabled by setting/clearing T0IE bit of the INTCON register. See Section 5.0 “Timer0 Module” for operation of the Timer0 module. An input change on PORTA sets the RAIF bit of the INTCON register. The interrupt can be enabled/disabled by setting/clearing the RAIE bit of the INTCON register. Plus, individual pins can be configured through the IOCA register. Note: FIGURE 12-7: PORTA INTERRUPT-ON-CHANGE If a change on the I/O pin should occur when any PORTA operation is being executed, then the RAIF interrupt flag may not get set. INTERRUPT LOGIC IOC-RA0 IOCA0 IOC-RA1 IOCA1 IOC-RA2 IOCA2 IOC-RA3 IOCA3 IOC-RA4 IOCA4 IOC-RA5 IOCA5 T0IF T0IE TMR2IF TMR2IE INTF INTE RAIF RAIE TMR1IF TMR1IE C1IF C1IE Wake-up (If in Sleep mode)(1) Interrupt to CPU PEIE GIE C2IF C2IE ADIF ADIE EEIF EEIE OSFIF OSFIE CCP1IF CCP1IE © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. Note 1: Some peripherals depend upon the system clock for operation. Since the system clock is suspended during Sleep, only those peripherals which do not depend upon the system clock will wake the part from Sleep. See Section 12.7.1 “Wake-up from Sleep”. DS41202F-page 107 PIC16F684 FIGURE 12-8: INT PIN INTERRUPT TIMING Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 OSC1 CLKOUT (3) (4) INT pin (1) (1) INTF flag (INTCON reg.) Interrupt Latency (2) (5) GIE bit (INTCON reg.) INSTRUCTION FLOW PC Instruction Fetched Inst (PC + 1) — Dummy Cycle Inst (PC) Inst (PC – 1) 0004h PC + 1 PC + 1 Inst (PC) Instruction Executed Note 1: PC 0005h Inst (0004h) Inst (0005h) Dummy Cycle Inst (0004h) INTF flag is sampled here (every Q1). 2: Asynchronous interrupt latency = 3-4 TCY. Synchronous latency = 3 TCY, where TCY = instruction cycle time. Latency is the same whether Inst (PC) is a single cycle or a 2-cycle instruction. 3: CLKOUT is available only in INTOSC and RC Oscillator modes. 4: For minimum width of INT pulse, refer to AC specifications in Section 15.0 “Electrical Specifications”. 5: INTF is enabled to be set any time during the Q4-Q1 cycles. TABLE 12-6: SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH INTERRUPTS Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Value on all other Resets Bit 7 Bit 6 INTCON GIE PEIE T0IE INTE RAIE T0IF INTF RAIF 0000 0000 0000 0000 — — IOCA5 IOCA4 IOCA3 IOCA2 IOCA1 IOCA0 --00 0000 --00 0000 IOCA Bit 5 Value on: POR, BOR Name PIR1 EEIF ADIF CCP1IF C2IF C1IF OSFIF TMR2IF TMR1IF 0000 0000 0000 0000 PIE1 EEIE ADIE CCP1IE C2IE C1IE OSFIE TMR2IE TMR1IE 0000 0000 0000 0000 Legend: x = unknown, u = unchanged, – = unimplemented read as ‘0’, q = value depends upon condition. Shaded cells are not used by the interrupt module. DS41202F-page 108 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 12.5 Context Saving During Interrupts During an interrupt, only the return PC value is saved on the stack. Typically, users may wish to save key registers during an interrupt (e.g., W and STATUS registers). This must be implemented in software. Temporary holding registers W_TEMP and STATUS_TEMP should be placed in the last 16 bytes of GPR (see Figure 2-2). These 16 locations are common to all banks and do not require banking. This makes context save and restore operations simpler. The code shown in Example 12-1 can be used to: • • • • • Store the W register Store the STATUS register Execute the ISR code Restore the Status (and Bank Select Bit register) Restore the W register Note: The PIC16F684 does not require saving the PCLATH. However, if computed GOTOs are used in both the ISR and the main code, the PCLATH must be saved and restored in the ISR. EXAMPLE 12-1: MOVWF SWAPF SAVING STATUS AND W REGISTERS IN RAM W_TEMP STATUS,W MOVWF STATUS_TEMP : :(ISR) : SWAPF STATUS_TEMP,W MOVWF SWAPF SWAPF STATUS W_TEMP,F W_TEMP,W © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. ;Copy W to TEMP ;Swap status to ;Swaps are used ;Save status to register be saved into W because they do not affect the status bits bank zero STATUS_TEMP register ;Insert user code here ;Swap STATUS_TEMP register into W ;(sets bank to original state) ;Move W into STATUS register ;Swap W_TEMP ;Swap W_TEMP into W DS41202F-page 109 PIC16F684 12.6 12.6.2 Watchdog Timer (WDT) The WDT has the following features: • • • • • Operates from the LFINTOSC (31 kHz) Contains a 16-bit prescaler Shares an 8-bit prescaler with Timer0 Time-out period is from 1 ms to 268 seconds Configuration bit and software controlled WDT is cleared under certain conditions described in Table 12-7. 12.6.1 WDT OSCILLATOR WDT CONTROL The WDTE bit is located in the Configuration Word register. When set, the WDT runs continuously. When the WDTE bit in the Configuration Word register is set, the SWDTEN bit of the WDTCON register has no effect. If WDTE is clear, then the SWDTEN bit can be used to enable and disable the WDT. Setting the bit will enable it and clearing the bit will disable it. The PSA and PS<2:0> bits of the OPTION register have the same function as in previous versions of the PIC16F684 Family of microcontrollers. See Section 5.0 “Timer0 Module” for more information. The WDT derives its time base from the 31 kHz LFINTOSC. The LTS bit of the OSCCON register does not reflect that the LFINTOSC is enabled. The value of WDTCON is ‘---0 1000’ on all Resets. This gives a nominal time base of 17 ms. Note: When the Oscillator Start-up Timer (OST) is invoked, the WDT is held in Reset, because the WDT Ripple Counter is used by the OST to perform the oscillator delay count. When the OST count has expired, the WDT will begin counting (if enabled). FIGURE 12-9: WATCHDOG TIMER BLOCK DIAGRAM From Timer0 Clock Source 0 Prescaler(1) 16-bit WDT Prescaler 1 8 PSA 31 kHz LFINTOSC Clock PS<2:0> WDTPS<3:0> To Timer0 0 1 PSA WDTE from the Configuration Word Register SWDTEN from WDTCON WDT Time-out Note 1: TABLE 12-7: This is the shared Timer0/WDT prescaler. See Section 5.0 “Timer0 Module” for more information. WDT STATUS Conditions WDT WDTE = 0 CLRWDT Command Oscillator Fail Detected Cleared Exit Sleep + System Clock = T1OSC, EXTRC, INTRC, EXTCLK Exit Sleep + System Clock = XT, HS, LP DS41202F-page 110 Cleared until the end of OST © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 REGISTER 12-2: WDTCON: WATCHDOG TIMER CONTROL REGISTER U-0 U-0 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-1 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — — — WDTPS3 WDTPS2 WDTPS1 WDTPS0 SWDTEN bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 7-5 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 4-1 WDTPS<3:0>: Watchdog Timer Period Select bits Bit Value = Prescale Rate 0000 = 1:32 0001 = 1:64 0010 = 1:128 0011 = 1:256 0100 = 1:512 (Reset value) 0101 = 1:1024 0110 = 1:2048 0111 = 1:4096 1000 = 1:8192 1001 = 1:16384 1010 = 1:32768 1011 = 1:65536 1100 = Reserved 1101 = Reserved 1110 = Reserved 1111 = Reserved bit 0 SWDTEN: Software Enable or Disable the Watchdog Timer(1) 1 = WDT is turned on 0 = WDT is turned off (Reset value) Note 1: If WDTE Configuration bit = 1, then WDT is always enabled, irrespective of this control bit. If WDTE Configuration bit = 0, then it is possible to turn WDT on/off with this control bit. TABLE 12-8: Name WDTCON Legend: Note 1: SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH WATCHDOG TIMER Bit 7 OPTION_REG CONFIG x = Bit is unknown Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 WDTPS3 WDTPS2 WSTPS1 WDTPS0 SWDTEN Value on: POR, BOR Value on all other Resets — — — ---0 1000 ---0 1000 RAPU INTEDG T0CS T0SE PSA PS2 PS1 PS0 1111 1111 1111 1111 CPD CP MCLRE PWRTE WDTE FOSC2 FOSC1 FOSC0 — — Shaded cells are not used by the Watchdog Timer. See Register 12-1 for operation of all Configuration Word register bits. © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 111 PIC16F684 12.7 Power-Down Mode (Sleep) The Power-down mode is entered by executing a SLEEP instruction. If the Watchdog Timer is enabled: • • • • • WDT will be cleared but keeps running. PD bit in the STATUS register is cleared. TO bit is set. Oscillator driver is turned off. I/O ports maintain the status they had before SLEEP was executed (driving high, low or high-impedance). For lowest current consumption in this mode, all I/O pins should be either at VDD or VSS, with no external circuitry drawing current from the I/O pin and the comparators and CVREF should be disabled. I/O pins that are high-impedance inputs should be pulled high or low externally to avoid switching currents caused by floating inputs. The T0CKI input should also be at VDD or VSS for lowest current consumption. The contribution from on-chip pull-ups on PORTA should be considered. The MCLR pin must be at a logic high level. Note: 12.7.1 It should be noted that a Reset generated by a WDT time-out does not drive MCLR pin low. WAKE-UP FROM SLEEP The device can wake-up from Sleep through one of the following events: 1. 2. 3. External Reset input on MCLR pin. Watchdog Timer wake-up (if WDT was enabled). Interrupt from RA2/INT pin, PORTA change or a peripheral interrupt. The first event will cause a device Reset. The two latter events are considered a continuation of program execution. The TO and PD bits in the STATUS register can be used to determine the cause of a device Reset. The PD bit, which is set on power-up, is cleared when Sleep is invoked. TO bit is cleared if WDT wake-up occurred. The following peripheral interrupts can wake the device from Sleep: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. Timer1 interrupt. Timer1 must be operating as an asynchronous counter. ECCP Capture mode interrupt. A/D conversion (when A/D clock source is FRC). EEPROM write operation completion. Comparator output changes state. Interrupt-on-change. External Interrupt from INT pin. When the SLEEP instruction is being executed, the next instruction (PC + 1) is prefetched. For the device to wake-up through an interrupt event, the corresponding interrupt enable bit must be set (enabled). Wake-up occurs regardless of the state of the GIE bit. If the GIE bit is clear (disabled), the device continues execution at the instruction after the SLEEP instruction. If the GIE bit is set (enabled), the device executes the instruction after the SLEEP instruction, then branches to the interrupt address (0004h). In cases where the execution of the instruction following SLEEP is not desirable, the user should have a NOP after the SLEEP instruction. Note: If the global interrupts are disabled (GIE is cleared) and any interrupt source has both its interrupt enable bit and the corresponding interrupt flag bits set, the device will immediately wake-up from Sleep. The WDT is cleared when the device wakes up from Sleep, regardless of the source of wake-up. 12.7.2 WAKE-UP USING INTERRUPTS When global interrupts are disabled (GIE cleared) and any interrupt source has both its interrupt enable bit and interrupt flag bit set, one of the following will occur: • If the interrupt occurs before the execution of a SLEEP instruction, the SLEEP instruction will complete as a NOP. Therefore, the WDT and WDT prescaler and postscaler (if enabled) will not be cleared, the TO bit will not be set and the PD bit will not be cleared. • If the interrupt occurs during or after the execution of a SLEEP instruction, the device will Immediately wake-up from Sleep. The SLEEP instruction is executed. Therefore, the WDT and WDT prescaler and postscaler (if enabled) will be cleared, the TO bit will be set and the PD bit will be cleared. Even if the flag bits were checked before executing a SLEEP instruction, it may be possible for flag bits to become set before the SLEEP instruction completes. To determine whether a SLEEP instruction executed, test the PD bit. If the PD bit is set, the SLEEP instruction was executed as a NOP. To ensure that the WDT is cleared, a CLRWDT instruction should be executed before a SLEEP instruction. See Figure 12-10 for more details. Other peripherals cannot generate interrupts since during Sleep, no on-chip clocks are present. DS41202F-page 112 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 FIGURE 12-10: WAKE-UP FROM SLEEP THROUGH INTERRUPT Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 OSC1 TOST(2) CLKOUT(4) INT pin INTF flag (INTCON reg.) Interrupt Latency (3) GIE bit (INTCON reg.) Instruction Flow PC Instruction Fetched Instruction Executed Note 12.8 Processor in Sleep PC Inst(PC) = Sleep Inst(PC – 1) PC + 1 PC + 2 PC + 2 Inst(PC + 1) Inst(PC + 2) Sleep Inst(PC + 1) PC + 2 Dummy Cycle 0004h 0005h Inst(0004h) Inst(0005h) Dummy Cycle Inst(0004h) 1: XT, HS or LP Oscillator mode assumed. 2: TOST = 1024 TOSC (drawing not to scale). This delay does not apply to EC, INTOSC and RC Oscillator modes. 3: GIE = ‘1’ assumed. In this case after wake-up, the processor jumps to 0004h. If GIE = ‘0’, execution will continue in-line. 4: CLKOUT is not available in XT, HS, LP or EC Oscillator modes, but shown here for timing reference. Code Protection If the code protection bit(s) have not been programmed, the on-chip program memory can be read out using ICSP™ for verification purposes. Note: 12.9 The entire data EEPROM and Flash program memory will be erased when the code protection is turned off. See the “PIC12F6XX/16F6XX Memory Programming Specification” (DS41204) for more information. ID Locations Four memory locations (2000h-2003h) are designated as ID locations where the user can store checksum or other code identification numbers. These locations are not accessible during normal execution but are readable and writable during Program/Verify mode. Only the Least Significant 7 bits of the ID locations are used. © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 113 PIC16F684 12.10 In-Circuit Serial Programming 12.11 In-Circuit Debugger The PIC16F684 microcontrollers can be serially programmed while in the end application circuit. This is simply done with five connections for: Since in-circuit debugging requires access to three pins, MPLAB® ICD 2 development with a 14-pin device is not practical. A special 20-pin PIC16F684 ICD device is used with MPLAB ICD 2 to provide separate clock, data and MCLR pins and frees all normally available pins to the user. clock data power ground programming voltage A special debugging adapter allows the ICD device to be used in place of a PIC16F684 device. The debugging adapter is the only source of the ICD device. This allows customers to manufacture boards with unprogrammed devices and then program the microcontroller just before shipping the product. This also allows the most recent firmware or a custom firmware to be programmed. The device is placed into a Program/Verify mode by holding the RA0 and RA1 pins low, while raising the MCLR (VPP) pin from VIL to VIHH. See the “PIC12F6XX/16F6XX Memory Programming Specification” (DS41204) for more information. RA0 becomes the programming data and RA1 becomes the programming clock. Both RA0 and RA1 are Schmitt Trigger inputs in Program/Verify mode. A typical In-Circuit Serial Programming connection is shown in Figure 12-11. FIGURE 12-11: TYPICAL IN-CIRCUIT SERIAL PROGRAMMING CONNECTION To Normal Connections External Connector Signals * VDD VSS 0V VPP MCLR/VPP/RA3 CLK RA1 Data I/O RA0 * * TABLE 12-9: DEBUGGER RESOURCES Resource Description I/O pins ICDCLK, ICDDATA Stack 1 level Program Memory Address 0h must be NOP 700h-7FFh For more information, see “MPLAB® ICD 2 In-Circuit Debugger User’s Guide” (DS51331), available on Microchip’s web site (www.microchip.com). FIGURE 12-12: PIC16F684 +5V When the ICD pin on the PIC16F684 ICD device is held low, the In-Circuit Debugger functionality is enabled. This function allows simple debugging functions when used with MPLAB ICD 2. When the microcontroller has this feature enabled, some of the resources are not available for general use. Table 12-9 shows which features are consumed by the background debugger. 20-PIN ICD PINOUT 20-Pin PDIP In-Circuit Debug Device NC 1 20 ICDMCLR/VPP VDD RA5 RA4 RA3 RC5 RC4 RC3 ICD 2 19 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 PIC16F684-ICD • • • • • 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 ICDCLK ICDDATA Vss RA0 RA1 RA2 RC0 RC1 RC2 NC * To Normal Connections * Isolation devices (as required) DS41202F-page 114 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 13.0 INSTRUCTION SET SUMMARY The PIC16F684 instruction set is highly orthogonal and is comprised of three basic categories: • Byte-oriented operations • Bit-oriented operations • Literal and control operations Each PIC16 instruction is a 14-bit word divided into an opcode, which specifies the instruction type and one or more operands, which further specify the operation of the instruction. The formats for each of the categories is presented in Figure 13-1, while the various opcode fields are summarized in Table 13-1. TABLE 13-1: Field The destination designator specifies where the result of the operation is to be placed. If ‘d’ is zero, the result is placed in the W register. If ‘d’ is one, the result is placed in the file register specified in the instruction. For bit-oriented instructions, ‘b’ represents a bit field designator, which selects the bit affected by the operation, while ‘f’ represents the address of the file in which the bit is located. For literal and control operations, ‘k’ represents an 8-bit or 11-bit constant, or literal value. One instruction cycle consists of four oscillator periods; for an oscillator frequency of 4 MHz, this gives a nominal instruction execution time of 1 μs. All instructions are executed within a single instruction cycle, unless a conditional test is true, or the program counter is changed as a result of an instruction. When this occurs, the execution takes two instruction cycles, with the second cycle executed as a NOP. All instruction examples use the format ‘0xhh’ to represent a hexadecimal number, where ‘h’ signifies a hexadecimal digit. Description Register file address (0x00 to 0x7F) f W Working register (accumulator) b Bit address within an 8-bit file register k Literal field, constant data or label x Don’t care location (= 0 or 1). The assembler will generate code with x = 0. It is the recommended form of use for compatibility with all Microchip software tools. d Destination select; d = 0: store result in W, d = 1: store result in file register f. Default is d = 1. Table 13-2 lists the instructions recognized by the MPASMTM assembler. For byte-oriented instructions, ‘f’ represents a file register designator and ‘d’ represents a destination designator. The file register designator specifies which file register is to be used by the instruction. OPCODE FIELD DESCRIPTIONS PC Program Counter TO Time-out bit Carry bit C DC Digit carry bit Zero bit Z PD Power-down bit FIGURE 13-1: GENERAL FORMAT FOR INSTRUCTIONS Byte-oriented file register operations 13 8 7 6 OPCODE d f (FILE #) 0 d = 0 for destination W d = 1 for destination f f = 7-bit file register address Bit-oriented file register operations 13 10 9 7 6 OPCODE b (BIT #) f (FILE #) 0 b = 3-bit bit address f = 7-bit file register address Literal and control operations General 13.1 Read-Modify-Write Operations 13 8 7 OPCODE Any instruction that specifies a file register as part of the instruction performs a Read-Modify-Write (R-M-W) operation. The register is read, the data is modified, and the result is stored according to either the instruction, or the destination designator ‘d’. A read operation is performed on a register even if the instruction writes to that register. For example, a CLRF PORTA instruction will read PORTA, clear all the data bits, then write the result back to PORTA. This example would have the unintended consequence of clearing the condition that set the RAIF flag. © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. 0 k (literal) k = 8-bit immediate value CALL and GOTO instructions only 13 11 OPCODE 10 0 k (literal) k = 11-bit immediate value DS41202F-page 115 PIC16F684 TABLE 13-2: PIC16F684 INSTRUCTION SET Mnemonic, Operands 14-Bit Opcode Description Cycles MSb LSb Status Affected Notes BYTE-ORIENTED FILE REGISTER OPERATIONS ADDWF ANDWF CLRF CLRW COMF DECF DECFSZ INCF INCFSZ IORWF MOVF MOVWF NOP RLF RRF SUBWF SWAPF XORWF f, d f, d f – f, d f, d f, d f, d f, d f, d f, d f – f, d f, d f, d f, d f, d Add W and f AND W with f Clear f Clear W Complement f Decrement f Decrement f, Skip if 0 Increment f Increment f, Skip if 0 Inclusive OR W with f Move f Move W to f No Operation Rotate Left f through Carry Rotate Right f through Carry Subtract W from f Swap nibbles in f Exclusive OR W with f BCF BSF BTFSC BTFSS f, b f, b f, b f, b Bit Clear f Bit Set f Bit Test f, Skip if Clear Bit Test f, Skip if Set 1 1 1 1 1 1 1(2) 1 1(2) 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 dfff dfff lfff 0xxx dfff dfff dfff dfff dfff dfff dfff lfff 0xx0 dfff dfff dfff dfff dfff ffff ffff ffff xxxx ffff ffff ffff ffff ffff ffff ffff ffff 0000 ffff ffff ffff ffff ffff 00bb 01bb 10bb 11bb bfff bfff bfff bfff ffff ffff ffff ffff 111x 1001 0kkk 0000 1kkk 1000 00xx 0000 01xx 0000 0000 110x 1010 kkkk kkkk kkkk 0110 kkkk kkkk kkkk 0000 kkkk 0000 0110 kkkk kkkk kkkk kkkk kkkk 0100 kkkk kkkk kkkk 1001 kkkk 1000 0011 kkkk kkkk 0111 0101 0001 0001 1001 0011 1011 1010 1111 0100 1000 0000 0000 1101 1100 0010 1110 0110 C, DC, Z Z Z Z Z Z Z Z Z C C C, DC, Z Z 1, 2 1, 2 2 1, 2 1, 2 1, 2, 3 1, 2 1, 2, 3 1, 2 1, 2 1, 2 1, 2 1, 2 1, 2 1, 2 BIT-ORIENTED FILE REGISTER OPERATIONS 1 1 1 (2) 1 (2) 01 01 01 01 1, 2 1, 2 3 3 LITERAL AND CONTROL OPERATIONS ADDLW ANDLW CALL CLRWDT GOTO IORLW MOVLW RETFIE RETLW RETURN SLEEP SUBLW XORLW Note 1: 2: 3: k k k – k k k – k – – k k Add literal and W AND literal with W Call Subroutine Clear Watchdog Timer Go to address Inclusive OR literal with W Move literal to W Return from interrupt Return with literal in W Return from Subroutine Go into Standby mode Subtract W from literal Exclusive OR literal with W 1 1 2 1 2 1 1 2 2 2 1 1 1 11 11 10 00 10 11 11 00 11 00 00 11 11 C, DC, Z Z TO, PD Z TO, PD C, DC, Z Z When an I/O register is modified as a function of itself (e.g., MOVF GPIO, 1), the value used will be that value present on the pins themselves. For example, if the data latch is ‘1’ for a pin configured as input and is driven low by an external device, the data will be written back with a ‘0’. If this instruction is executed on the TMR0 register (and where applicable, d = 1), the prescaler will be cleared if assigned to the Timer0 module. If the Program Counter (PC) is modified, or a conditional test is true, the instruction requires two cycles. The second cycle is executed as a NOP. DS41202F-page 116 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 13.2 Instruction Descriptions ADDLW Add literal and W Syntax: [ label ] ADDLW Operands: 0 ≤ k ≤ 255 Operation: (W) + k → (W) Status Affected: C, DC, Z Description: The contents of the W register are added to the eight-bit literal ‘k’ and the result is placed in the W register. k BCF Bit Clear f Syntax: [ label ] BCF Operands: 0 ≤ f ≤ 127 0≤b≤7 Operation: 0 → (f<b>) Status Affected: None Description: Bit ‘b’ in register ‘f’ is cleared. BSF Bit Set f Syntax: [ label ] BSF f,b ADDWF Add W and f Syntax: [ label ] ADDWF Operands: 0 ≤ f ≤ 127 d ∈ [0,1] Operands: 0 ≤ f ≤ 127 0≤b≤7 Operation: (W) + (f) → (destination) Operation: 1 → (f<b>) Status Affected: C, DC, Z Status Affected: None Description: Add the contents of the W register with register ‘f’. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is stored in the W register. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is stored back in register ‘f’. Description: Bit ‘b’ in register ‘f’ is set. ANDLW AND literal with W BTFSC Bit Test, Skip if Clear Syntax: [ label ] ANDLW Syntax: [ label ] BTFSC f,b Operands: 0 ≤ k ≤ 255 Operands: Operation: (W) .AND. (k) → (W) 0 ≤ f ≤ 127 0≤b≤7 Status Affected: Z Operation: skip if (f<b>) = 0 Description: The contents of W register are AND’ed with the eight-bit literal ‘k’. The result is placed in the W register. Status Affected: None Description: If bit ‘b’ in register ‘f’ is ‘1’, the next instruction is executed. If bit ‘b’, in register ‘f’, is ‘0’, the next instruction is discarded, and a NOP is executed instead, making this a 2-cycle instruction. ANDWF f,d k AND W with f Syntax: [ label ] ANDWF Operands: 0 ≤ f ≤ 127 d ∈ [0,1] Operation: (W) .AND. (f) → (destination) f,d Status Affected: Z Description: AND the W register with register ‘f’. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is stored in the W register. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is stored back in register ‘f’. © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. f,b DS41202F-page 117 PIC16F684 BTFSS Bit Test f, Skip if Set CLRWDT Clear Watchdog Timer Syntax: [ label ] BTFSS f,b Syntax: [ label ] CLRWDT Operands: 0 ≤ f ≤ 127 0≤b<7 Operands: None Operation: 00h → WDT 0 → WDT prescaler, 1 → TO 1 → PD Status Affected: TO, PD Description: CLRWDT instruction resets the Watchdog Timer. It also resets the prescaler of the WDT. Status bits TO and PD are set. Operation: skip if (f<b>) = 1 Status Affected: None Description: If bit ‘b’ in register ‘f’ is ‘0’, the next instruction is executed. If bit ‘b’ is ‘1’, then the next instruction is discarded and a NOP is executed instead, making this a 2-cycle instruction. CALL Call Subroutine COMF Complement f Syntax: [ label ] CALL k Syntax: [ label ] COMF Operands: 0 ≤ k ≤ 2047 Operands: Operation: (PC)+ 1→ TOS, k → PC<10:0>, (PCLATH<4:3>) → PC<12:11> 0 ≤ f ≤ 127 d ∈ [0,1] Operation: (f) → (destination) Status Affected: Z Description: The contents of register ‘f’ are complemented. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is stored in W. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is stored back in register ‘f’. DECF Decrement f Syntax: [ label ] DECF f,d f,d Status Affected: None Description: Call Subroutine. First, return address (PC + 1) is pushed onto the stack. The eleven-bit immediate address is loaded into PC bits <10:0>. The upper bits of the PC are loaded from PCLATH. CALL is a two-cycle instruction. CLRF Clear f Syntax: [ label ] CLRF Operands: 0 ≤ f ≤ 127 Operands: Operation: 00h → (f) 1→Z 0 ≤ f ≤ 127 d ∈ [0,1] Operation: (f) - 1 → (destination) Status Affected: Z Status Affected: Z Description: The contents of register ‘f’ are cleared and the Z bit is set. Description: Decrement register ‘f’. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is stored in the W register. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is stored back in register ‘f’. CLRW Clear W Syntax: [ label ] CLRW f Operands: None Operation: 00h → (W) 1→Z Status Affected: Z Description: W register is cleared. Zero bit (Z) is set. DS41202F-page 118 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 DECFSZ Decrement f, Skip if 0 INCFSZ Increment f, Skip if 0 Syntax: [ label ] DECFSZ f,d Syntax: [ label ] Operands: 0 ≤ f ≤ 127 d ∈ [0,1] Operands: 0 ≤ f ≤ 127 d ∈ [0,1] Operation: (f) - 1 → (destination); skip if result = 0 Operation: (f) + 1 → (destination), skip if result = 0 Status Affected: None Status Affected: None Description: The contents of register ‘f’ are decremented. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is placed in the W register. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is placed back in register ‘f’. If the result is ‘1’, the next instruction is executed. If the result is ‘0’, then a NOP is executed instead, making it a 2-cycle instruction. Description: The contents of register ‘f’ are incremented. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is placed in the W register. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is placed back in register ‘f’. If the result is ‘1’, the next instruction is executed. If the result is ‘0’, a NOP is executed instead, making it a 2-cycle instruction. GOTO Unconditional Branch IORLW Syntax: [ label ] Syntax: [ label ] Operands: 0 ≤ k ≤ 2047 Operands: 0 ≤ k ≤ 255 Operation: k → PC<10:0> PCLATH<4:3> → PC<12:11> Operation: (W) .OR. k → (W) Status Affected: Z Status Affected: None Description: Description: GOTO is an unconditional branch. The eleven-bit immediate value is loaded into PC bits <10:0>. The upper bits of PC are loaded from PCLATH<4:3>. GOTO is a two-cycle instruction. The contents of the W register are OR’ed with the eight-bit literal ‘k’. The result is placed in the W register. INCF Increment f IORWF Inclusive OR W with f Syntax: [ label ] Syntax: [ label ] Operands: 0 ≤ f ≤ 127 d ∈ [0,1] Operands: 0 ≤ f ≤ 127 d ∈ [0,1] Operation: (f) + 1 → (destination) Operation: (W) .OR. (f) → (destination) Status Affected: Z Status Affected: Z Description: The contents of register ‘f’ are incremented. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is placed in the W register. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is placed back in register ‘f’. Description: Inclusive OR the W register with register ‘f’. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is placed in the W register. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is placed back in register ‘f’. GOTO k INCF f,d © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. INCFSZ f,d Inclusive OR literal with W IORLW k IORWF f,d DS41202F-page 119 PIC16F684 MOVF Move f Syntax: [ label ] Operands: 0 ≤ f ≤ 127 d ∈ [0,1] MOVF f,d MOVWF Move W to f Syntax: [ label ] MOVWF Operands: 0 ≤ f ≤ 127 Operation: (W) → (f) f Operation: (f) → (dest) Status Affected: None Status Affected: Z Description: Description: The contents of register f is moved to a destination dependent upon the status of d. If d = 0, destination is W register. If d = 1, the destination is file register f itself. d = 1 is useful to test a file register since status flag Z is affected. Move data from W register to register ‘f’. Words: 1 Cycles: 1 Words: 1 Cycles: 1 Example: MOVF Example: MOVW F OPTION Before Instruction OPTION = W = After Instruction OPTION = W = FSR, 0 0xFF 0x4F 0x4F 0x4F After Instruction W = value in FSR register Z = 1 MOVLW Move literal to W NOP No Operation Syntax: [ label ] Syntax: [ label ] Operands: 0 ≤ k ≤ 255 Operands: None Operation: k → (W) Operation: No operation Status Affected: None Status Affected: None Description: The eight-bit literal ‘k’ is loaded into W register. The “don’t cares” will assemble as ‘0’s. Description: No operation. Words: 1 Cycles: 1 Words: 1 Cycles: 1 Example: MOVLW k Example: MOVLW NOP 0x5A After Instruction W = DS41202F-page 120 NOP 0x5A © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 RETFIE Return from Interrupt RETLW Return with literal in W Syntax: [ label ] Syntax: [ label ] Operands: None Operands: 0 ≤ k ≤ 255 Operation: TOS → PC, 1 → GIE Operation: k → (W); TOS → PC Status Affected: None Status Affected: None Description: Return from Interrupt. Stack is POPed and Top-of-Stack (TOS) is loaded in the PC. Interrupts are enabled by setting Global Interrupt Enable bit, GIE (INTCON<7>). This is a two-cycle instruction. Description: The W register is loaded with the eight bit literal ‘k’. The program counter is loaded from the top of the stack (the return address). This is a two-cycle instruction. Words: 1 Cycles: 2 Example: RETFIE Words: 1 Cycles: 2 Example: RETFIE After Interrupt PC = GIE = TABLE TOS 1 RETLW k CALL TABLE;W contains table ;offset value • ;W now has table value • • ADDWF PC ;W = offset RETLW k1 ;Begin table RETLW k2 ; • • • RETLW kn ; End of table Before Instruction W = 0x07 After Instruction W = value of k8 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. RETURN Return from Subroutine Syntax: [ label ] Operands: None Operation: TOS → PC Status Affected: None Description: Return from subroutine. The stack is POPed and the top of the stack (TOS) is loaded into the program counter. This is a two-cycle instruction. RETURN DS41202F-page 121 PIC16F684 RLF Rotate Left f through Carry SLEEP Enter Sleep mode Syntax: [ label ] Syntax: [ label ] SLEEP Operands: 0 ≤ f ≤ 127 d ∈ [0,1] Operands: None Operation: Operation: See description below Status Affected: C Description: The contents of register ‘f’ are rotated one bit to the left through the Carry flag. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is placed in the W register. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is stored back in register ‘f’. 00h → WDT, 0 → WDT prescaler, 1 → TO, 0 → PD RLF f,d C Words: 1 Cycles: 1 Example: Status Affected: TO, PD Description: The power-down Status bit, PD is cleared. Time-out Status bit, TO is set. Watchdog Timer and its prescaler are cleared. The processor is put into Sleep mode with the oscillator stopped. Register f RLF REG1,0 Before Instruction REG1 C = = 1110 0110 0 = = = 1110 0110 1100 1100 1 After Instruction REG1 W C RRF Rotate Right f through Carry SUBLW Syntax: [ label ] Syntax: [ label ] SUBLW k Operands: 0 ≤ f ≤ 127 d ∈ [0,1] Operands: 0 ≤ k ≤ 255 Operation: k - (W) → (W) Operation: See description below Status Affected: C, DC, Z Status Affected: C Description: Description: The contents of register ‘f’ are rotated one bit to the right through the Carry flag. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is placed in the W register. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is placed back in register ‘f’. RRF f,d C DS41202F-page 122 Register f Subtract W from literal The W register is subtracted (2’s complement method) from the eight-bit literal ‘k’. The result is placed in the W register. C=0 W>k C=1 W≤k DC = 0 W<3:0> > k<3:0> DC = 1 W<3:0> ≤ k<3:0> © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 SUBWF Subtract W from f XORLW Exclusive OR literal with W Syntax: [ label ] SUBWF f,d Syntax: [ label ] XORLW k Operands: 0 ≤ f ≤ 127 d ∈ [0,1] Operands: 0 ≤ k ≤ 255 (f) - (W) → (destination) Operation: (W) .XOR. k → (W) Operation: Status Affected: Z Description: The contents of the W register are XOR’ed with the eight-bit literal ‘k’. The result is placed in the W register. Status Affected: C, DC, Z Description: SWAPF Subtract (2’s complement method) W register from register ‘f’. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is stored in the W register. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is stored back in register ‘f. C=0 W>f C=1 W≤f DC = 0 W<3:0> > f<3:0> DC = 1 W<3:0> ≤ f<3:0> Swap Nibbles in f XORWF Exclusive OR W with f Syntax: [ label ] SWAPF f,d Syntax: [ label ] XORWF Operands: 0 ≤ f ≤ 127 d ∈ [0,1] Operands: 0 ≤ f ≤ 127 d ∈ [0,1] Operation: (f<3:0>) → (destination<7:4>), (f<7:4>) → (destination<3:0>) Operation: (W) .XOR. (f) → (destination) Status Affected: Z Status Affected: None Description: Description: The upper and lower nibbles of register ‘f’ are exchanged. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is placed in the W register. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is placed in register ‘f’. Exclusive OR the contents of the W register with register ‘f’. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is stored in the W register. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is stored back in register ‘f’. © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. f,d DS41202F-page 123 PIC16F684 NOTES: DS41202F-page 124 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 14.0 DEVELOPMENT SUPPORT The PIC® microcontrollers are supported with a full range of hardware and software development tools: • Integrated Development Environment - MPLAB® IDE Software • Assemblers/Compilers/Linkers - MPASMTM Assembler - MPLAB C18 and MPLAB C30 C Compilers - MPLINKTM Object Linker/ MPLIBTM Object Librarian - MPLAB ASM30 Assembler/Linker/Library • Simulators - MPLAB SIM Software Simulator • Emulators - MPLAB ICE 2000 In-Circuit Emulator - MPLAB REAL ICE™ In-Circuit Emulator • In-Circuit Debugger - MPLAB ICD 2 • Device Programmers - PICSTART® Plus Development Programmer - MPLAB PM3 Device Programmer - PICkit™ 2 Development Programmer • Low-Cost Demonstration and Development Boards and Evaluation Kits 14.1 MPLAB Integrated Development Environment Software The MPLAB IDE software brings an ease of software development previously unseen in the 8/16-bit microcontroller market. The MPLAB IDE is a Windows® operating system-based application that contains: • A single graphical interface to all debugging tools - Simulator - Programmer (sold separately) - Emulator (sold separately) - In-Circuit Debugger (sold separately) • A full-featured editor with color-coded context • A multiple project manager • Customizable data windows with direct edit of contents • High-level source code debugging • Visual device initializer for easy register initialization • Mouse over variable inspection • Drag and drop variables from source to watch windows • Extensive on-line help • Integration of select third party tools, such as HI-TECH Software C Compilers and IAR C Compilers The MPLAB IDE allows you to: • Edit your source files (either assembly or C) • One touch assemble (or compile) and download to PIC MCU emulator and simulator tools (automatically updates all project information) • Debug using: - Source files (assembly or C) - Mixed assembly and C - Machine code MPLAB IDE supports multiple debugging tools in a single development paradigm, from the cost-effective simulators, through low-cost in-circuit debuggers, to full-featured emulators. This eliminates the learning curve when upgrading to tools with increased flexibility and power. © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 125 PIC16F684 14.2 MPASM Assembler The MPASM Assembler is a full-featured, universal macro assembler for all PIC MCUs. The MPASM Assembler generates relocatable object files for the MPLINK Object Linker, Intel® standard HEX files, MAP files to detail memory usage and symbol reference, absolute LST files that contain source lines and generated machine code and COFF files for debugging. The MPASM Assembler features include: • Integration into MPLAB IDE projects • User-defined macros to streamline assembly code • Conditional assembly for multi-purpose source files • Directives that allow complete control over the assembly process 14.5 MPLAB ASM30 Assembler produces relocatable machine code from symbolic assembly language for dsPIC30F devices. MPLAB C30 C Compiler uses the assembler to produce its object file. The assembler generates relocatable object files that can then be archived or linked with other relocatable object files and archives to create an executable file. Notable features of the assembler include: • • • • • • Support for the entire dsPIC30F instruction set Support for fixed-point and floating-point data Command line interface Rich directive set Flexible macro language MPLAB IDE compatibility 14.6 14.3 MPLAB C18 and MPLAB C30 C Compilers The MPLAB C18 and MPLAB C30 Code Development Systems are complete ANSI C compilers for Microchip’s PIC18 and PIC24 families of microcontrollers and the dsPIC30 and dsPIC33 family of digital signal controllers. These compilers provide powerful integration capabilities, superior code optimization and ease of use not found with other compilers. For easy source level debugging, the compilers provide symbol information that is optimized to the MPLAB IDE debugger. 14.4 MPLINK Object Linker/ MPLIB Object Librarian The MPLINK Object Linker combines relocatable objects created by the MPASM Assembler and the MPLAB C18 C Compiler. It can link relocatable objects from precompiled libraries, using directives from a linker script. MPLAB ASM30 Assembler, Linker and Librarian MPLAB SIM Software Simulator The MPLAB SIM Software Simulator allows code development in a PC-hosted environment by simulating the PIC MCUs and dsPIC® DSCs on an instruction level. On any given instruction, the data areas can be examined or modified and stimuli can be applied from a comprehensive stimulus controller. Registers can be logged to files for further run-time analysis. The trace buffer and logic analyzer display extend the power of the simulator to record and track program execution, actions on I/O, most peripherals and internal registers. The MPLAB SIM Software Simulator fully supports symbolic debugging using the MPLAB C18 and MPLAB C30 C Compilers, and the MPASM and MPLAB ASM30 Assemblers. The software simulator offers the flexibility to develop and debug code outside of the hardware laboratory environment, making it an excellent, economical software development tool. The MPLIB Object Librarian manages the creation and modification of library files of precompiled code. When a routine from a library is called from a source file, only the modules that contain that routine will be linked in with the application. This allows large libraries to be used efficiently in many different applications. The object linker/library features include: • Efficient linking of single libraries instead of many smaller files • Enhanced code maintainability by grouping related modules together • Flexible creation of libraries with easy module listing, replacement, deletion and extraction DS41202F-page 126 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 14.7 MPLAB ICE 2000 High-Performance In-Circuit Emulator The MPLAB ICE 2000 In-Circuit Emulator is intended to provide the product development engineer with a complete microcontroller design tool set for PIC microcontrollers. Software control of the MPLAB ICE 2000 In-Circuit Emulator is advanced by the MPLAB Integrated Development Environment, which allows editing, building, downloading and source debugging from a single environment. The MPLAB ICE 2000 is a full-featured emulator system with enhanced trace, trigger and data monitoring features. Interchangeable processor modules allow the system to be easily reconfigured for emulation of different processors. The architecture of the MPLAB ICE 2000 In-Circuit Emulator allows expansion to support new PIC microcontrollers. The MPLAB ICE 2000 In-Circuit Emulator system has been designed as a real-time emulation system with advanced features that are typically found on more expensive development tools. The PC platform and Microsoft® Windows® 32-bit operating system were chosen to best make these features available in a simple, unified application. 14.8 MPLAB REAL ICE In-Circuit Emulator System MPLAB REAL ICE In-Circuit Emulator System is Microchip’s next generation high-speed emulator for Microchip Flash DSC® and MCU devices. It debugs and programs PIC® and dsPIC® Flash microcontrollers with the easy-to-use, powerful graphical user interface of the MPLAB Integrated Development Environment (IDE), included with each kit. The MPLAB REAL ICE probe is connected to the design engineer’s PC using a high-speed USB 2.0 interface and is connected to the target with either a connector compatible with the popular MPLAB ICD 2 system (RJ11) or with the new high speed, noise tolerant, lowvoltage differential signal (LVDS) interconnection (CAT5). 14.9 MPLAB ICD 2 In-Circuit Debugger Microchip’s In-Circuit Debugger, MPLAB ICD 2, is a powerful, low-cost, run-time development tool, connecting to the host PC via an RS-232 or high-speed USB interface. This tool is based on the Flash PIC MCUs and can be used to develop for these and other PIC MCUs and dsPIC DSCs. The MPLAB ICD 2 utilizes the in-circuit debugging capability built into the Flash devices. This feature, along with Microchip’s In-Circuit Serial ProgrammingTM (ICSPTM) protocol, offers costeffective, in-circuit Flash debugging from the graphical user interface of the MPLAB Integrated Development Environment. This enables a designer to develop and debug source code by setting breakpoints, single stepping and watching variables, and CPU status and peripheral registers. Running at full speed enables testing hardware and applications in real time. MPLAB ICD 2 also serves as a development programmer for selected PIC devices. 14.10 MPLAB PM3 Device Programmer The MPLAB PM3 Device Programmer is a universal, CE compliant device programmer with programmable voltage verification at VDDMIN and VDDMAX for maximum reliability. It features a large LCD display (128 x 64) for menus and error messages and a modular, detachable socket assembly to support various package types. The ICSP™ cable assembly is included as a standard item. In Stand-Alone mode, the MPLAB PM3 Device Programmer can read, verify and program PIC devices without a PC connection. It can also set code protection in this mode. The MPLAB PM3 connects to the host PC via an RS-232 or USB cable. The MPLAB PM3 has high-speed communications and optimized algorithms for quick programming of large memory devices and incorporates an SD/MMC card for file storage and secure data applications. MPLAB REAL ICE is field upgradeable through future firmware downloads in MPLAB IDE. In upcoming releases of MPLAB IDE, new devices will be supported, and new features will be added, such as software breakpoints and assembly code trace. MPLAB REAL ICE offers significant advantages over competitive emulators including low-cost, full-speed emulation, real-time variable watches, trace analysis, complex breakpoints, a ruggedized probe interface and long (up to three meters) interconnection cables. © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 127 PIC16F684 14.11 PICSTART Plus Development Programmer 14.13 Demonstration, Development and Evaluation Boards The PICSTART Plus Development Programmer is an easy-to-use, low-cost, prototype programmer. It connects to the PC via a COM (RS-232) port. MPLAB Integrated Development Environment software makes using the programmer simple and efficient. The PICSTART Plus Development Programmer supports most PIC devices in DIP packages up to 40 pins. Larger pin count devices, such as the PIC16C92X and PIC17C76X, may be supported with an adapter socket. The PICSTART Plus Development Programmer is CE compliant. A wide variety of demonstration, development and evaluation boards for various PIC MCUs and dsPIC DSCs allows quick application development on fully functional systems. Most boards include prototyping areas for adding custom circuitry and provide application firmware and source code for examination and modification. 14.12 PICkit 2 Development Programmer The PICkit™ 2 Development Programmer is a low-cost programmer and selected Flash device debugger with an easy-to-use interface for programming many of Microchip’s baseline, mid-range and PIC18F families of Flash memory microcontrollers. The PICkit 2 Starter Kit includes a prototyping development board, twelve sequential lessons, software and HI-TECH’s PICC™ Lite C compiler, and is designed to help get up to speed quickly using PIC® microcontrollers. The kit provides everything needed to program, evaluate and develop applications using Microchip’s powerful, mid-range Flash memory family of microcontrollers. DS41202F-page 128 The boards support a variety of features, including LEDs, temperature sensors, switches, speakers, RS-232 interfaces, LCD displays, potentiometers and additional EEPROM memory. The demonstration and development boards can be used in teaching environments, for prototyping custom circuits and for learning about various microcontroller applications. In addition to the PICDEM™ and dsPICDEM™ demonstration/development board series of circuits, Microchip has a line of evaluation kits and demonstration software for analog filter design, KEELOQ® security ICs, CAN, IrDA®, PowerSmart® battery management, SEEVAL® evaluation system, Sigma-Delta ADC, flow rate sensing, plus many more. Check the Microchip web page (www.microchip.com) and the latest “Product Selector Guide” (DS00148) for the complete list of demonstration, development and evaluation kits. © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 15.0 ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS Absolute Maximum Ratings(†) Ambient temperature under bias..........................................................................................................-40° to +125°C Storage temperature ........................................................................................................................ -65°C to +150°C Voltage on VDD with respect to VSS ................................................................................................... -0.3V to +6.5V Voltage on MCLR with respect to Vss ............................................................................................... -0.3V to +13.5V Voltage on all other pins with respect to VSS ........................................................................... -0.3V to (VDD + 0.3V) Total power dissipation(1) ............................................................................................................................... 800 mW Maximum current out of VSS pin ...................................................................................................................... 95 mA Maximum current into VDD pin ......................................................................................................................... 95 mA Input clamp current, IIK (VI < 0 or VI > VDD)...............................................................................................................± 20 mA Output clamp current, IOK (Vo < 0 or Vo >VDD).........................................................................................................± 20 mA Maximum output current sunk by any I/O pin.................................................................................................... 25 mA Maximum output current sourced by any I/O pin .............................................................................................. 25 mA Maximum current sunk by PORTA and PORTC (combined) ........................................................................... 90 mA Maximum current sourced PORTA and PORTC (combined) ........................................................................... 90 mA Note 1: Power dissipation is calculated as follows: PDIS = VDD x {IDD – ∑ IOH} + ∑ {(VDD – VOH) x IOH} + ∑(VOl x IOL). † NOTICE: Stresses above those listed under “Absolute Maximum Ratings” may cause permanent damage to the device. This is a stress rating only and functional operation of the device at those or any other conditions above those indicated in the operation listings of this specification is not implied. Exposure above maximum rating conditions for extended periods may affect device reliability. © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 129 PIC16F684 FIGURE 15-1: PIC16F684 VOLTAGE-FREQUENCY GRAPH, -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C 5.5 5.0 VDD (V) 4.5 4.0 3.5 3.0 2.5 2.0 0 8 10 20 Frequency (MHz) Note 1: The shaded region indicates the permissible combinations of voltage and frequency. HFINTOSC FREQUENCY ACCURACY OVER DEVICE VDD AND TEMPERATURE FIGURE 15-2: 125 ± 5% Temperature (°C) 85 ± 2% 60 ± 1% 25 0 2.0 2.5 3.0 3.5 4.0 4.5 5.0 5.5 VDD (V) DS41202F-page 130 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 15.1 DC Characteristics: PIC16F684-I (Industrial) PIC16F684-E (Extended) DC CHARACTERISTICS Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for industrial -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for extended Param No. Min Typ† Max Sym Characteristic Unit s Conditions VDD Supply Voltage 2.0 2.0 3.0 4.5 — — — — 5.5 5.5 5.5 5.5 V V V V FOSC < = 8 MHz: HFINTOSC, EC FOSC < = 4 MHz FOSC < = 10 MHz FOSC < = 20 MHz D002* VDR RAM Data Retention Voltage(1) 1.5 — — V Device in Sleep mode D003 VPOR VDD Start Voltage to ensure internal Power-on Reset signal — VSS — V See Section 12.3.1 “Power-On Reset (POR)” for details. D004* SVDD VDD Rise Rate to ensure internal Power-on Reset signal 0.05 — — D001 D001C D001D V/ms See Section 12.3.1 “Power-On Reset (POR)” for details. * These parameters are characterized but not tested. † Data in “Typ” column is at 5.0V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance only and are not tested. Note 1: This is the limit to which VDD can be lowered in Sleep mode without losing RAM data. © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 131 PIC16F684 15.2 DC Characteristics: PIC16F684-I (Industrial) PIC16F684-E (Extended) Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for industrial -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for extended DC CHARACTERISTICS Param No. D010 Conditions Device Characteristics Min Typ† Max Units VDD Supply Current (IDD) D011* D012 D013* D014 D015 D016* D017 D018 D019 (1, 2) — 11 16 μA 2.0 — 18 28 μA 3.0 — 35 54 μA 5.0 — 140 240 μA 2.0 — 220 380 μA 3.0 — 380 550 μA 5.0 — 260 360 μA 2.0 — 420 650 μA 3.0 — 0.8 1.1 mA 5.0 — 130 220 μA 2.0 — 215 360 μA 3.0 — 360 520 μA 5.0 — 220 340 μA 2.0 — 375 550 μA 3.0 — 0.65 1.0 mA 5.0 — 8 20 μA 2.0 — 16 40 μA 3.0 — 31 65 μA 5.0 — 340 450 μA 2.0 — 500 700 μA 3.0 — 0.8 1.2 mA 5.0 — 410 650 μA 2.0 — 700 950 μA 3.0 — 1.30 1.65 mA 5.0 — 230 400 μA 2.0 — 400 680 μA 3.0 — 0.63 1.1 mA 5.0 — 2.6 3.25 mA 4.5 — 2.8 3.35 mA 5.0 Note FOSC = 32 kHz LP Oscillator mode FOSC = 1 MHz XT Oscillator mode FOSC = 4 MHz XT Oscillator mode FOSC = 1 MHz EC Oscillator mode FOSC = 4 MHz EC Oscillator mode FOSC = 31 kHz LFINTOSC mode FOSC = 4 MHz HFINTOSC mode FOSC = 8 MHz HFINTOSC mode FOSC = 4 MHz EXTRC mode(3) FOSC = 20 MHz HS Oscillator mode * These parameters are characterized but not tested. † Data in ‘Typ’ column is at 5.0V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance only and are not tested. Note 1: The test conditions for all IDD measurements in active operation mode are: OSC1 = external square wave, from rail-to-rail; all I/O pins tri-stated, pulled to VDD; MCLR = VDD; WDT disabled. 2: The supply current is mainly a function of the operating voltage and frequency. Other factors, such as I/O pin loading and switching rate, oscillator type, internal code execution pattern and temperature, also have an impact on the current consumption. 3: For RC oscillator configurations, current through REXT is not included. The current through the resistor can be extended by the formula IR = VDD/2REXT (mA) with REXT in kΩ. DS41202F-page 132 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 15.3 DC Characteristics: PIC16F684-I (Industrial) DC CHARACTERISTICS Param No. D020 Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for industrial Conditions Device Characteristics Power-down Base Current(IPD)(2) D021 D022 D023 D024 D025* D026 D027 Min Typ† Max Units VDD Note WDT, BOR, Comparators, VREF and T1OSC disabled — 0.05 1.2 μA 2.0 — 0.15 1.5 μA 3.0 — 0.35 1.8 μA 5.0 — 150 500 nA 3.0 -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +25°C — 1.0 2.2 μA 2.0 WDT Current(1) — 2.0 4.0 μA 3.0 — 3.0 7.0 μA 5.0 — 42 60 μA 3.0 — 85 122 μA 5.0 — 32 45 μA 2.0 — 60 78 μA 3.0 — 120 160 μA 5.0 — 30 36 μA 2.0 — 45 55 μA 3.0 — 75 95 μA 5.0 — 39 47 μA 2.0 — 59 72 μA 3.0 — 98 124 μA 5.0 — 4.5 7.0 μA 2.0 — 5.0 8.0 μA 3.0 — 6.0 12 μA 5.0 — 0.30 1.6 μA 3.0 — 0.36 1.9 μA 5.0 BOR Current(1) Comparator Current(1), both comparators enabled CVREF Current(1) (high range) CVREF Current(1) (low range) T1OSC Current(1), 32.768 kHz A/D Current(1), no conversion in progress * These parameters are characterized but not tested. † Data in ‘Typ’ column is at 5.0V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance only and are not tested. Note 1: The peripheral current is the sum of the base IDD or IPD and the additional current consumed when this peripheral is enabled. The peripheral Δ current can be determined by subtracting the base IDD or IPD current from this limit. Max values should be used when calculating total current consumption. 2: The power-down current in Sleep mode does not depend on the oscillator type. Power-down current is measured with the part in Sleep mode, with all I/O pins in high-impedance state and tied to VDD. © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 133 PIC16F684 15.4 DC Characteristics: PIC16F684-E (Extended) DC CHARACTERISTICS Param No. D020E Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for extended Conditions Device Characteristics Power-down Base Current (IPD)(2) D021E D022E D023E D024E D025E* D026E D027E Min — Typ† 0.05 Max 9 Units μA VDD Note 2.0 WDT, BOR, Comparators, VREF and T1OSC disabled — 0.15 11 μA 3.0 — 0.35 15 μA 5.0 — 1 17.5 μA 2.0 — 2 19 μA 3.0 — 3 22 μA 5.0 — 42 65 μA 3.0 — 85 127 μA 5.0 — 32 45 μA 2.0 — 60 78 μA 3.0 — 120 160 μA 5.0 — 30 70 μA 2.0 — 45 90 μA 3.0 — 75 120 μA 5.0 — 39 91 μA 2.0 — 59 117 μA 3.0 — 98 156 μA 5.0 — 4.5 25 μA 2.0 — 5 30 μA 3.0 — 6 40 μA 5.0 — 0.30 12 μA 3.0 — 0.36 16 μA 5.0 WDT Current(1) BOR Current(1) Comparator Current(1), both comparators enabled CVREF Current(1) (high range) CVREF Current(1) (low range) T1OSC Current(1), 32.768 kHz A/D Current(1), no conversion in progress * These parameters are characterized but not tested. † Data in ‘Typ’ column is at 5.0V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance only and are not tested. Note 1: The peripheral current is the sum of the base IDD or IPD and the additional current consumed when this peripheral is enabled. The peripheral Δ current can be determined by subtracting the base IDD or IPD current from this limit. Max values should be used when calculating total current consumption. 2: The power-down current in Sleep mode does not depend on the oscillator type. Power-down current is measured with the part in Sleep mode, with all I/O pins in high-impedance state and tied to VDD. DS41202F-page 134 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 15.5 DC Characteristics: PIC16F684-I (Industrial) PIC16F684-E (Extended) Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for industrial -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for extended DC CHARACTERISTICS Param No. Sym VIL Characteristic Min Typ† Max Units Vss Vss Conditions — 0.8 V 4.5V ≤ VDD ≤ 5.5V — 0.15 VDD V 2.0V ≤ VDD ≤ 4.5V Vss — 0.2 VDD V 2.0V ≤ VDD ≤ 5.5V Input Low Voltage I/O Port: D030 with TTL buffer D030A D031 with Schmitt Trigger buffer (1) D032 MCLR, OSC1 (RC mode) VSS — 0.2 VDD V D033 OSC1 (XT and LP modes) VSS — 0.3 V OSC1 (HS mode) VSS — 0.3 VDD V D033A VIH Input High Voltage I/O ports: D040 — with TTL buffer D040A D041 with Schmitt Trigger buffer 2.0 — VDD V 4.5V ≤ VDD ≤ 5.5V 0.25 VDD + 0.8 — VDD V 2.0V ≤ VDD ≤ 4.5V 0.8 VDD — VDD V 2.0V ≤ VDD ≤ 5.5V 0.8 VDD — VDD V 1.6 — VDD V D042 MCLR D043 OSC1 (XT and LP modes) D043A OSC1 (HS mode) 0.7 VDD — VDD V D043B OSC1 (RC mode) 0.9 VDD — VDD V (Note 1) (2) Input Leakage Current IIL D060 I/O ports — ± 0.1 ±1 μA VSS ≤ VPIN ≤ VDD, Pin at high-impedance D061 MCLR(3) — ± 0.1 ±5 μA VSS ≤ VPIN ≤ VDD D063 OSC1 — ± 0.1 ±5 μA VSS ≤ VPIN ≤ VDD, XT, HS and LP oscillator configuration IPUR PORTA Weak Pull-up Current 50 250 400 μA VDD = 5.0V, VPIN = VSS VOL Output Low Voltage(5) — — 0.6 V IOL = 8.5 mA, VDD = 4.5V (Ind.) VDD – 0.7 — — V IOH = -3.0 mA, VDD = 4.5V (Ind.) D070* D080 I/O ports VOH D090 Output High Voltage(5) I/O ports * † Note 1: 2: 3: 4: 5: These parameters are characterized but not tested. Data in ‘Typ’ column is at 5.0V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance only and are not tested. In RC oscillator configuration, the OSC1/CLKIN pin is a Schmitt Trigger input. It is not recommended to use an external clock in RC mode. Negative current is defined as current sourced by the pin. The leakage current on the MCLR pin is strongly dependent on the applied voltage level. The specified levels represent normal operating conditions. Higher leakage current may be measured at different input voltages. See Section 10.4.1 “Using the Data EEPROM” for additional information. Including OSC2 in CLKOUT mode. © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 135 PIC16F684 15.5 DC Characteristics: PIC16F684-I (Industrial) PIC16F684-E (Extended) (Continued) DC CHARACTERISTICS Param No. Sym D100 IULP Characteristic Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for industrial -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for extended Min Typ† Max Units — 200 — nA See Application Note AN879, “Using the Microchip Ultra Low-Power Wake-up Module” (DS00879) OSC2 pin — — 15 pF In XT, HS and LP modes when external clock is used to drive OSC1 All I/O pins — — 50 pF Ultra Low-Power Wake-Up Current Conditions Capacitive Loading Specs on Output Pins D101* COSC2 D101A* CIO Data EEPROM Memory -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C D120 ED Byte Endurance 100K 1M — E/W D120A ED Byte Endurance 10K 100K — E/W D121 VDRW VDD for Read/Write VMIN — 5.5 V D122 TDEW Erase/Write Cycle Time — 5 6 D123 TRETD Characteristic Retention 40 — — Year Provided no other specifications are violated D124 TREF Number of Total Erase/Write Cycles before Refresh(4) 1M 10M — E/W -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C +85°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C Using EECON1 to read/write VMIN = Minimum operating voltage ms Program Flash Memory D130 EP Cell Endurance 10K 100K — E/W D130A ED Cell Endurance 1K 10K — E/W D131 VPR VDD for Read VMIN — 5.5 V D132 VPEW VDD for Erase/Write 4.5 — 5.5 V D133 TPEW Erase/Write cycle time — 2 2.5 ms D134 TRETD Characteristic Retention 40 — — * † Note 1: 2: 3: 4: 5: +85°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C VMIN = Minimum operating voltage Year Provided no other specifications are violated These parameters are characterized but not tested. Data in ‘Typ’ column is at 5.0V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance only and are not tested. In RC oscillator configuration, the OSC1/CLKIN pin is a Schmitt Trigger input. It is not recommended to use an external clock in RC mode. Negative current is defined as current sourced by the pin. The leakage current on the MCLR pin is strongly dependent on the applied voltage level. The specified levels represent normal operating conditions. Higher leakage current may be measured at different input voltages. See Section 10.4.1 “Using the Data EEPROM” for additional information. Including OSC2 in CLKOUT mode. DS41202F-page 136 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 15.6 Thermal Considerations Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C Param No. TH01 TH02 TH03 TH04 TH05 TH06 TH07 Note 1: 2: 3: Sym θJA Characteristic Thermal Resistance Junction to Ambient Typ Units 69.8 85.0 100.4 46.3 32.5 31.0 31.7 2.6 150 — — C/W C/W C/W C/W C/W C/W C/W C/W C W W Conditions 14-pin PDIP package 14-pin SOIC package 14-pin TSSOP package 16-pin QFN 4x0.9mm package θJC Thermal Resistance 14-pin PDIP package Junction to Case 14-pin SOIC package 14-pin TSSOP package 16-pin QFN 4x0.9mm package TJ Junction Temperature For derated power calculations PD Power Dissipation PD = PINTERNAL + PI/O PINTERNAL Internal Power Dissipation PINTERNAL = IDD x VDD (NOTE 1) PI/O I/O Power Dissipation — W PI/O = Σ (IOL * VOL) + Σ (IOH * (VDD - VOH)) PDER Derated Power — W PDER = (TJ - TA)/θJA (NOTE 2, 3) IDD is current to run the chip alone without driving any load on the output pins. TA = Ambient Temperature. Maximum allowable power dissipation is the lower value of either the absolute maximum total power dissipation or derated power (PDER). © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 137 PIC16F684 15.7 Timing Parameter Symbology The timing parameter symbols have been created with one of the following formats: 1. TppS2ppS 2. TppS T F Frequency Lowercase letters (pp) and their meanings: pp cc CCP1 ck CLKOUT cs CS di SDI do SDO dt Data in io I/O PORT mc MCLR Uppercase letters and their meanings: S F Fall H High I Invalid (High-impedance) L Low FIGURE 15-3: T Time osc rd rw sc ss t0 t1 wr OSC1 RD RD or WR SCK SS T0CKI T1CKI WR P R V Z Period Rise Valid High-impedance LOAD CONDITIONS Load Condition Pin CL VSS Legend: CL = DS41202F-page 138 50 pF for all pins 15 pF for OSC2 output © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 15.8 AC Characteristics: PIC16F684 (Industrial, Extended) FIGURE 15-4: CLOCK TIMING Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 OSC1/CLKIN OS02 OS04 OS04 OS03 OSC2/CLKOUT (LP,XT,HS Modes) OSC2/CLKOUT (CLKOUT Mode) TABLE 15-1: CLOCK OSCILLATOR TIMING REQUIREMENTS Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C Param No. OS01 Sym FOSC Characteristic External CLKIN Frequency(1) Oscillator Frequency(1) OS02 TOSC External CLKIN Period(1) Oscillator Period(1) OS03 OS04* TCY TosH, TosL Min Typ† Max Units DC DC DC DC — 0.1 1 DC 27 250 50 50 — 250 50 250 — — — — 32.768 — — — — — — — 30.5 — — — 37 4 20 20 — 4 20 4 • • • • — 10,000 1,000 — kHz MHz MHz MHz kHz MHz MHz MHz μs ns ns ns μs ns ns ns Conditions LP Oscillator mode XT Oscillator mode HS Oscillator mode EC Oscillator mode LP Oscillator mode XT Oscillator mode HS Oscillator mode RC Oscillator mode LP Oscillator mode XT Oscillator mode HS Oscillator mode EC Oscillator mode LP Oscillator mode XT Oscillator mode HS Oscillator mode RC Oscillator mode Instruction Cycle Time(1) External CLKIN High, External CLKIN Low 200 TCY DC ns TCY = 4/FOSC 2 — — μs LP oscillator 100 — — ns XT oscillator 20 — — ns HS oscillator OS05* TosR, External CLKIN Rise, 0 — • ns LP oscillator TosF External CLKIN Fall 0 — • ns XT oscillator 0 — • ns HS oscillator * These parameters are characterized but not tested. † Data in ‘Typ’ column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance only and are not tested. Note 1: Instruction cycle period (TCY) equals four times the input oscillator time base period. All specified values are based on characterization data for that particular oscillator type under standard operating conditions with the device executing code. Exceeding these specified limits may result in an unstable oscillator operation and/or higher than expected current consumption. All devices are tested to operate at ‘min’ values with an external clock applied to OSC1 pin. When an external clock input is used, the ‘max’ cycle time limit is ‘DC’ (no clock) for all devices. © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 139 PIC16F684 TABLE 15-2: OSCILLATOR PARAMETERS Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated) Operating Temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C Param No. Sym Characteristic Freq Tolerance Min Typ† Max Units Conditions OS06 TWARM Internal Oscillator Switch when running(3) — — — 2 TOSC Slowest clock OS07 TSC Fail-Safe Sample Clock Period(1) — — 21 — ms LFINTOSC/64 OS08 HFOSC Internal Calibrated HFINTOSC Frequency(2) OS09* OS10* LFOSC Internal Uncalibrated LFINTOSC Frequency TIOSC HFINTOSC Oscillator Wake-up from Sleep Start-up Time ST ±1% 7.92 8.0 8.08 MHz VDD = 3.5V, 25°C ±2% 7.84 8.0 8.16 MHz 2.5V ≤ VDD ≤ 5.5V, 0°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C ±5% 7.60 8.0 8.40 MHz 2.0V ≤ VDD ≤ 5.5V, -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C (Ind.), -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C (Ext.) — 15 31 45 kHz — 5.5 12 24 μs VDD = 2.0V, -40°C to +85°C — 3.5 7 14 μs VDD = 3.0V, -40°C to +85°C — 3 6 11 μs VDD = 5.0V, -40°C to +85°C * These parameters are characterized but not tested. † Data in ‘Typ’ column is at 5.0V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance only and are not tested. Note 1: Instruction cycle period (TCY) equals four times the input oscillator time base period. All specified values are based on characterization data for that particular oscillator type under standard operating conditions with the device executing code. Exceeding these specified limits may result in an unstable oscillator operation and/or higher than expected current consumption. All devices are tested to operate at ‘min’ values with an external clock applied to the OSC1 pin. When an external clock input is used, the ‘max’ cycle time limit is ‘DC’ (no clock) for all devices. 2: To ensure these oscillator frequency tolerances, VDD and VSS must be capacitively decoupled as close to the device as possible. 0.1 μF and 0.01 μF values in parallel are recommended. 3: By design. DS41202F-page 140 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 FIGURE 15-5: CLKOUT AND I/O TIMING Cycle Write Fetch Read Execute Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Fosc OS12 OS11 OS20 OS21 CLKOUT OS19 OS18 OS16 OS13 OS17 I/O pin (Input) OS14 OS15 I/O pin (Output) New Value Old Value OS18, OS19 TABLE 15-3: CLKOUT AND I/O TIMING PARAMETERS Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated) Operating Temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C Param No. Sym Characteristic TOSH2CKL FOSC↑ to CLKOUT↓ (1) OS12 TOSH2CKH FOSC↑ to CLKOUT↑ (1) OS13 TCKL2IOV CLKOUT↓ to Port out valid(1) OS14 TIOV2CKH Port input valid before CLKOUT↑(1) OS15 TOSH2IOV OS16 OS11 Min Typ† Max Units Conditions — — 70 ns VDD = 5.0V VDD = 5.0V — — 72 ns — — 20 ns TOSC + 200 ns — — ns FOSC↑ (Q1 cycle) to Port out valid — 50 70* ns VDD = 5.0V TOSH2IOI FOSC↑ (Q2 cycle) to Port input invalid (I/O in hold time) 50 — — ns VDD = 5.0V OS17 TIOV2OSH Port input valid to FOSC↑ (Q2 cycle) (I/O in setup time) 20 — — ns OS18 TIOR Port output rise time(2) — — 15 40 72 32 ns VDD = 2.0V VDD = 5.0V OS19 TIOF Port output fall time(2) — — 28 15 55 30 ns VDD = 2.0V VDD = 5.0V OS20* TINP INT pin input high or low time 25 — — ns OS21* TRAP PORTA interrupt-on-change new input level time TCY — — ns * † Note 1: 2: These parameters are characterized but not tested. Data in ‘Typ’ column is at 5.0V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. Measurements are taken in RC mode where CLKOUT output is 4 x TOSC. Includes OSC2 in CLKOUT mode. © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 141 PIC16F684 FIGURE 15-6: RESET, WATCHDOG TIMER, OSCILLATOR START-UP TIMER AND POWER-UP TIMER TIMING VDD MCLR 30 Internal POR 33 PWRT Time-out 32 OSC Start-Up Time Internal Reset(1) Watchdog Timer Reset(1) 31 34 34 I/O pins Note 1: Asserted low. FIGURE 15-7: BROWN-OUT RESET TIMING AND CHARACTERISTICS VDD VBOR + VHYST VBOR (Device in Brown-out Reset) (Device not in Brown-out Reset) 37 Reset (due to BOR) * 33* 64 ms delay only if PWRTE bit in the Configuration Word register is programmed to ‘0’. DS41202F-page 142 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 TABLE 15-4: RESET, WATCHDOG TIMER, OSCILLATOR START-UP TIMER, POWER-UP TIMER AND BROWN-OUT RESET PARAMETERS Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated) Operating Temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C Param No. Sym Characteristic Min Typ† Max Units Conditions 30 TMCL MCLR Pulse Width (low) 2 5 — — — — μs μs VDD = 5V, -40°C to +85°C VDD = 5V 31 TWDT Watchdog Timer Time-out Period (No Prescaler) 10 10 16 16 29 31 ms ms VDD = 5V, -40°C to +85°C VDD = 5V 32 TOST Oscillation Start-up Timer Period(1, 2) — 1024 — 33* TPWRT Power-up Timer Period 40 65 140 ms 34* TIOZ I/O High-impedance from MCLR Low or Watchdog Timer Reset — — 2.0 μs 35 VBOR Brown-out Reset Voltage 2.0 — 2.2 V 36* VHYST Brown-out Reset Hysteresis — 50 — mV 37* TBOR Brown-out Reset Minimum Detection Period 100 — — μs TOSC (NOTE 3) (NOTE 4) VDD ≤ VBOR * These parameters are characterized but not tested. † Data in ‘Typ’ column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance only and are not tested. Note 1: Instruction cycle period (TCY) equals four times the input oscillator time base period. All specified values are based on characterization data for that particular oscillator type under standard operating conditions with the device executing code. Exceeding these specified limits may result in an unstable oscillator operation and/or higher than expected current consumption. All devices are tested to operate at ‘min’ values with an external clock applied to the OSC1 pin. When an external clock input is used, the ‘max’ cycle time limit is ‘DC’ (no clock) for all devices. 2: By design. 3: Period of the slower clock. 4: To ensure these voltage tolerances, VDD and VSS must be capacitively decoupled as close to the device as possible. 0.1 μF and 0.01 μF values in parallel are recommended. © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 143 PIC16F684 FIGURE 15-8: TIMER0 AND TIMER1 EXTERNAL CLOCK TIMINGS T0CKI 40 41 42 T1CKI 45 46 49 47 TMR0 or TMR1 TABLE 15-5: TIMER0 AND TIMER1 EXTERNAL CLOCK REQUIREMENTS Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated) Operating Temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C Param No. 40* Sym TT0H Characteristic T0CKI High Pulse Width No Prescaler With Prescaler 41* TT0L T0CKI Low Pulse Width No Prescaler 42* TT0P T0CKI Period 45* TT1H T1CKI High Synchronous, No Prescaler Time Synchronous, with Prescaler With Prescaler Asynchronous 46* TT1L T1CKI Low Time Synchronous, No Prescaler Synchronous, with Prescaler Asynchronous 47* TT1P T1CKI Input Synchronous Period 48 FT1 Timer1 Oscillator Input Frequency Range (oscillator enabled by setting bit T1OSCEN) 49* TCKEZTMR1 Delay from External Clock Edge to Timer Increment Asynchronous * † Min Typ† Max Units 0.5 TCY + 20 — — ns 10 — — ns 0.5 TCY + 20 — — ns 10 — — ns Greater of: 20 or TCY + 40 N — — ns 0.5 TCY + 20 — — ns 15 — — ns 30 — — ns 0.5 TCY + 20 — — ns 15 — — ns 30 — — ns Greater of: 30 or TCY + 40 N — — ns 60 — — ns — 32.768 — kHz 2 TOSC — 7 TOSC — Conditions N = prescale value (2, 4, ..., 256) N = prescale value (1, 2, 4, 8) Timers in Sync mode These parameters are characterized but not tested. Data in ‘Typ’ column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance only and are not tested. DS41202F-page 144 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 FIGURE 15-9: CAPTURE/COMPARE/PWM TIMINGS (ECCP) CCP1 (Capture mode) CC01 CC02 CC03 Note: TABLE 15-6: Refer to Figure 15-3 for load conditions. CAPTURE/COMPARE/PWM REQUIREMENTS (ECCP) Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated) Operating Temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C Param No. CC01* CC02* CC03* Sym TccL TccH TccP Characteristic CCP1 Input Low Time CCP1 Input High Time CCP1 Input Period Min Typ† Max Units No Prescaler 0.5TCY + 20 — — ns With Prescaler 20 — — ns No Prescaler 0.5TCY + 20 — — ns With Prescaler 20 — — ns 3TCY + 40 N — — ns Conditions N = prescale value (1, 4 or 16) * These parameters are characterized but not tested. † Data in ‘Typ’ column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance only and are not tested. © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 145 PIC16F684 TABLE 15-7: COMPARATOR SPECIFICATIONS Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated) Operating Temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C Param No. Sym Characteristics CM01 VOS Input Offset Voltage CM02 VCM Input Common Mode Voltage CM03* CMRR Common Mode Rejection Ratio CM04* TRT Response Time Min Typ† Max Units — ± 5.0 ± 10 mV 0 — VDD – 1.5 V +55 — — dB Falling — 150 600 ns Rising — 200 1000 ns — — 10 μs CM05* TMC2COV Comparator Mode Change to Output Valid Comments (VDD - 1.5)/2 (NOTE 1) * These parameters are characterized but not tested. † Data in ‘Typ’ column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance only and are not tested. Note 1: Response time is measured with one comparator input at (VDD - 1.5)/2 - 100 mV to (VDD - 1.5)/2 + 20 mV. TABLE 15-8: COMPARATOR VOLTAGE REFERENCE (CVREF) SPECIFICATIONS Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C Param No. Sym Characteristics Min Typ† Max Units Comments CV01* CLSB Step Size(2) — — VDD/24 VDD/32 — — V V Low Range (VRR = 1) High Range (VRR = 0) CV02* CACC Absolute Accuracy — — — — ± 1/2 ± 1/2 LSb LSb Low Range (VRR = 1) High Range (VRR = 0) CV03* CR Unit Resistor Value (R) — 2k — Ω CV04* CST Settling Time(1) — — 10 μs * These parameters are characterized but not tested. † Data in ‘Typ’ column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance only and are not tested. Note 1: Settling time measured while VRR = 1 and VR<3:0> transitions from ‘0000’ to ‘1111’. 2: See Section 8.10 “Comparator Voltage Reference” for more information. DS41202F-page 146 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 TABLE 15-9: PIC16F684 A/D CONVERTER (ADC) CHARACTERISTICS Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C Param Sym No. Characteristic Min Typ† Max Units Conditions AD01 NR Resolution — — 10 bits AD02 EIL Integral Error — — ±1 LSb VREF = 5.12V AD03 EDL Differential Error — — ±1 LSb No missing codes to 10 bits VREF = 5.12V AD04 EOFF Offset Error — — ±1 LSb VREF = 5.12V AD07 EGN LSb VREF = 5.12V bit Gain Error — — ±1 AD06 VREF AD06A Reference Voltage(3) 2.2 2.7 — — VDD V AD07 VAIN Full-Scale Range VSS — VREF V AD08 ZAIN Recommended Impedance of Analog Voltage Source — — 10 kΩ AD09* IREF VREF Input Current(3) 10 — 1000 μA During VAIN acquisition. Based on differential of VHOLD to VAIN. — — 50 μA During A/D conversion cycle. Absolute minimum to ensure 1 LSb accuracy * These parameters are characterized but not tested. † Data in ‘Typ’ column is at 5.0V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance only and are not tested. Note 1: Total Absolute Error includes integral, differential, offset and gain errors. 2: The A/D conversion result never decreases with an increase in the input voltage and has no missing codes. 3: ADC VREF is from external VREF or VDD pin, whichever is selected as reference input. 4: When ADC is off, it will not consume any current other than leakage current. The power-down current specification includes any such leakage from the ADC module. © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 147 PIC16F684 TABLE 15-10: PIC16F684 A/D CONVERSION REQUIREMENTS Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C Param No. Sym AD130* TAD Characteristic A/D Clock Period A/D Internal RC Oscillator Period AD131 TCNV Conversion Time (not including Acquisition Time)(1) Min Typ† 1.6 — 9.0 μs TOSC-based, VREF ≥ 3.0V 3.0 — 9.0 μs TOSC-based, VREF full range 3.0 6.0 9.0 μs ADCS<1:0> = 11 (ADRC mode) At VDD = 2.5V 1.6 4.0 6.0 μs At VDD = 5.0V — 11 — TAD Set GO/DONE bit to new data in A/D Result register 11.5 — μs Amplifier Settling Time — — 5 μs Q4 to A/D Clock Start — TOSC/2 — — — TOSC/2 + TCY — — AD132* TACQ Acquisition Time AD133* TAMP AD134 TGO Max Units Conditions If the A/D clock source is selected as RC, a time of TCY is added before the A/D clock starts. This allows the SLEEP instruction to be executed. * These parameters are characterized but not tested. † Data in ‘Typ’ column is at 5.0V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance only and are not tested. Note 1: ADRESH and ADRESL registers may be read on the following TCY cycle. 2: See Section 9.3 “A/D Acquisition Requirements” for minimum conditions. DS41202F-page 148 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 FIGURE 15-10: PIC16F684 A/D CONVERSION TIMING (NORMAL MODE) BSF ADCON0, GO AD134 1 TCY (TOSC/2(1)) AD131 Q4 AD130 A/D CLK 9 A/D Data 8 7 6 3 2 1 0 NEW_DATA OLD_DATA ADRES 1 TCY ADIF GO DONE Note 1: Sampling Stopped AD132 Sample If the A/D clock source is selected as RC, a time of TCY is added before the A/D clock starts. This allows the SLEEP instruction to be executed. FIGURE 15-11: PIC16F684 A/D CONVERSION TIMING (SLEEP MODE) BSF ADCON0, GO AD134 (TOSC/2 + TCY(1)) 1 TCY AD131 Q4 AD130 A/D CLK 9 A/D Data 8 7 6 OLD_DATA ADRES 3 2 1 0 NEW_DATA ADIF 1 TCY GO DONE Sample Note 1: AD132 Sampling Stopped If the A/D clock source is selected as RC, a time of TCY is added before the A/D clock starts. This allows the SLEEP instruction to be executed. © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 149 PIC16F684 NOTES: DS41202F-page 150 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 16.0 DC AND AC CHARACTERISTICS GRAPHS AND TABLES The graphs and tables provided in this section are for design guidance and are not tested. In some graphs or tables, the data presented are outside specified operating range (i.e., outside specified VDD range). This is for information only and devices are ensured to operate properly only within the specified range. Note: The graphs and tables provided following this note are a statistical summary based on a limited number of samples and are provided for informational purposes only. The performance characteristics listed herein are not tested or guaranteed. In some graphs or tables, the data presented may be outside the specified operating range (e.g., outside specified power supply range) and therefore, outside the warranted range. “Typical” represents the mean of the distribution at 25°C. “Maximum” or “minimum” represents (mean + 3σ) or (mean - 3σ) respectively, where σ is a standard deviation, over each temperature range. FIGURE 16-1: TYPICAL IDD vs. FOSC OVER VDD (EC MODE) 3.5 3.0 Typical: Statistical Mean @25°C Maximum: Mean (Worst Case Temp) + 3σ (-40°C to 125°C) 5.5V 5.0V IDD (mA) 2.5 2.0 4.0V 1.5 3.0V 1.0 2.0V 0.5 0.0 1 MHz 2 MHz 4 MHz 6 MHz 8 MHz 10 MHz 12 MHz 14 MHz 16 MHz 18 MHz 20 MHz FOSC © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 151 PIC16F684 FIGURE 16-2: MAXIMUM IDD vs. FOSC OVER VDD (EC MODE) EC Mode 4.0 3.5 Typical: Statistical Mean @25°C Maximum: Mean (Worst Case Temp) + 3σ (-40°C to 125°C) 5.5V 5.0V 3.0 IDD (mA) 2.5 4.0V 2.0 3.0V 1.5 2.0V 1.0 0.5 0.0 1 MHz 2 MHz 4 MHz 6 MHz 8 MHz 10 MHz 12 MHz 14 MHz 16 MHz 18 MHz 20 MHz FOSC FIGURE 16-3: TYPICAL IDD vs. FOSC OVER VDD (HS MODE) Typical IDD vs FOSC Over Vdd HS Mode 4.0 3.5 Typical: Statistical Mean @25°C Maximum: Mean (Worst Case Temp) + 3σ (-40°C to 125°C) 5.5V 3.0 5.0V IDD (mA) 2.5 4.5V 2.0 1.5 4.0V 3.5V 3.0V 1.0 0.5 0.0 4 MHz 10 MHz 16 MHz 20 MHz FOSC DS41202F-page 152 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 FIGURE 16-4: MAXIMUM IDD vs. FOSC OVER VDD (HS MODE) Maximum IDD vs FOSC Over Vdd HS Mode 5.0 4.5 4.0 Typical: Statistical Mean @25°C Maximum: Mean (Worst Case Temp) + 3σ (-40°C to 125°C) 5.5V IDD (mA) 3.5 5.0V 3.0 4.5V 2.5 2.0 1.5 4.0V 3.5V 3.0V 1.0 0.5 0.0 4 MHz 10 MHz 16 MHz 20 MHz FOSC FIGURE 16-5: TYPICAL IDD vs. VDD OVER FOSC (XT MODE) XT Mode 900 800 Typical: Statistical Mean @25°C Maximum: Mean (Worst Case Temp) + 3σ (-40°C to 125°C) 700 IDD (μA) 600 500 4 MHz 400 300 1 MHz 200 100 0 2.0 2.5 3.0 3.5 4.0 4.5 5.0 5.5 VDD (V) © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 153 PIC16F684 FIGURE 16-6: MAXIMUM IDD vs. VDD OVER FOSC (XT MODE) XT Mode 1,400 Typical: Statistical Mean @25°C Maximum: Mean (Worst Case Temp) + 3σ (-40°C to 125°C) 1,200 IDD (μA) 1,000 800 4 MHz 600 400 1 MHz 200 0 2.0 2.5 3.0 3.5 4.0 4.5 5.0 5.5 5.0 5.5 VDD (V) FIGURE 16-7: TYPICAL IDD vs. VDD OVER FOSC (EXTRC MODE) EXTRC Mode 800 700 Typical: Statistical Mean @25°C Maximum: Mean (Worst Case Temp) + 3σ (-40°C to 125°C) 600 IDD (μA) 500 4 MHz 400 300 1 MHz 200 100 0 2.0 2.5 3.0 3.5 4.0 4.5 VDD (V) DS41202F-page 154 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 FIGURE 16-8: MAXIMUM IDD vs. VDD OVER FOSC (EXTRC MODE) EXTRC Mode 1,400 Typical: Statistical Mean @25°C Maximum: Mean (Worst Case Temp) + 3σ (-40°C to 125°C) 1,200 IDD (μA) 1,000 4 MHz 800 600 1 MHz 400 200 0 2.0 2.5 3.0 3.5 4.0 4.5 5.0 5.5 5.0 5.5 VDD (V) FIGURE 16-9: IDD vs. VDD OVER FOSC (LFINTOSC MODE, 31 kHz) LFINTOSC Mode, 31KHZ 80 70 Typical: Statistical Mean @25°C Maximum: Mean (Worst Case Temp) + 3σ (-40°C to 125°C) 60 IDD (μA) 50 Maximum 40 30 Typical 20 10 0 2.0 2.5 3.0 3.5 4.0 4.5 VDD (V) © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 155 PIC16F684 FIGURE 16-10: IDD vs. VDD OVER FOSC (LP MODE) LP Mode 70 Typical: Statistical Mean @25°C Maximum: Mean (Worst Case Temp) + 3σ (-40°C to 125°C) 60 50 IDD (μA) 32 kHz Maximum 40 30 32 kHz Typical 20 10 0 2.0 2.5 3.0 3.5 4.0 4.5 5.0 5.5 VDD (V) FIGURE 16-11: TYPICAL IDD vs. FOSC OVER VDD (HFINTOSC MODE) HFINTOSC 1,600 1,400 Typical: Statistical Mean @25°C Maximum: Mean (Worst Case Temp) + 3σ (-40°C to 125°C) 5.5V 5.0V 1,200 IDD (μA) 1,000 4.0V 800 3.0V 600 2.0V 400 200 0 125 kHz 250 kHz 500 kHz 1 MHz 2 MHz 4 MHz 8 MHz FOSC DS41202F-page 156 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 FIGURE 16-12: MAXIMUM IDD vs. FOSC OVER VDD (HFINTOSC MODE) HFINTOSC 2,000 1,800 Typical: Statistical Mean @25°C Maximum: Mean (Worst Case Temp) + 3σ (-40°C to 125°C) 5.5V 5.0V 1,600 1,400 4.0V IDD (μA) 1,200 1,000 3.0V 800 600 2.0V 400 200 0 125 kHz 250 kHz 500 kHz 1 MHz 2 MHz 4 MHz 8 MHz FOSC FIGURE 16-13: TYPICAL IPD vs. VDD (SLEEP MODE, ALL PERIPHERALS DISABLED) Typical (Sleep Mode all Peripherals Disabled) 0.45 0.40 Typical: Statistical Mean @25°C Maximum: Mean (Worst Case Temp) + 3σ (-40°C to 125°C) 0.35 IPD (μA) 0.30 0.25 0.20 0.15 0.10 0.05 0.0 2.0 2.5 3.0 3.5 4.0 4.5 5.0 5.5 VDD (V) © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 157 PIC16F684 FIGURE 16-14: MAXIMUM IPD vs. VDD (SLEEP MODE, ALL PERIPHERALS DISABLED) Maximum (Sleep Mode all Peripherals Disabled) 18.0 16.0 Typical: Statistical Mean @25°C Maximum: 3σ Case Temp) + 3σ Maximum: Mean Mean + (Worst (-40°C to 125°C) 14.0 Max. 125°C IPD (μA) 12.0 10.0 8.0 6.0 4.0 Max. 85°C 2.0 0.0 2.0 2.5 3.0 3.5 4.0 4.5 5.0 5.5 VDD (V) FIGURE 16-15: COMPARATOR IPD vs. VDD (BOTH COMPARATORS ENABLED) 180 160 140 Typical: Statistical Mean @25°C Maximum: Mean (Worst Case Temp) + 3σ (-40°C to 125°C) IPD (μA) 120 Maximum 100 Typical 80 60 40 20 0 2.0 2.5 3.0 3.5 4.0 4.5 5.0 5.5 VDD (V) DS41202F-page 158 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 FIGURE 16-16: BOR IPD vs. VDD OVER TEMPERATURE 160 140 Typical: Statistical Mean @25°C Maximum: Mean (Worst Case Temp) + 3σ (-40°C to 125°C) 120 IPD (μA) 100 Maximum 80 Typical 60 40 20 0 2.5 3.0 3.5 4.0 4.5 5.0 5.5 VDD (V) FIGURE 16-17: TYPICAL WDT IPD vs. VDD OVER TEMPERATURE Typical 3.0 2.5 Typical: Statistical StatisticalMean Mean @25°C @25°C Typical: Maximum: Mean (Worst Case Temp) + 3σ (-40°C to 125°C) IPD (μA) 2.0 1.5 1.0 0.5 0.0 2.0 2.5 3.0 3.5 4.0 4.5 5.0 5.5 VDD (V) © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 159 PIC16F684 FIGURE 16-18: MAXIMUM WDT IPD vs. VDD OVER TEMPERATURE Maximum 25.0 20.0 IPD (μA) Max. 125°C 15.0 Typical: Statistical Mean @25°C Maximum: Mean (Worst Case Temp) + 3σ (-40°C to 125°C) 10.0 Max. 85°C 5.0 0.0 2.0 2.5 3.0 3.5 4.0 4.5 5.0 5.5 VDD (V) FIGURE 16-19: WDT PERIOD vs. VDD OVER TEMPERATURE 30 28 Typical: Statistical Mean @25°C Maximum: Mean (Worst Case Temp) + 3σ (-40°C to 125°C) Max. (125°C) 26 Max. (85°C) 24 Time (ms) 22 20 Typical 18 16 14 Minimum 12 10 2.0 2.5 3.0 3.5 4.0 4.5 5.0 5.5 VDD (V) DS41202F-page 160 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 FIGURE 16-20: WDT PERIOD vs. TEMPERATURE OVER VDD (5.0V) Vdd = 5V 30 28 Typical: Statistical Mean @25°C Maximum: Mean (Worst Case Temp) + 3σ (-40°C to 125°C) 26 Maximum 24 Time (ms) 22 20 Typical 18 16 Minimum 14 12 10 -40°C 25°C 85°C 125°C Temperature (°C) FIGURE 16-21: CVREF IPD vs. VDD OVER TEMPERATURE (HIGH RANGE) High Range 140 120 Typical: Statistical Mean @25°C Maximum: Mean (Worst Case Temp) + 3σ (-40°C to 125°C) 100 IPD (μA) Max. 125°C 80 Max. 85°C 60 Typical 40 20 0 2.0 2.5 3.0 3.5 4.0 4.5 5.0 5.5 VDD (V) © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 161 PIC16F684 FIGURE 16-22: CVREF IPD vs. VDD OVER TEMPERATURE (LOW RANGE) 180 Typical: Statistical Mean @25°C Maximum: Mean (Worst Case Temp) + 3σ (-40°C to 125°C) 160 140 120 IPD (μA) Max. 125°C 100 Max. 85°C 80 Typical 60 40 20 0 2.0 2.5 3.0 3.5 4.0 4.5 5.0 5.5 VDD (V) FIGURE 16-23: VOL vs. IOL OVER TEMPERATURE (VDD = 3.0V) (VDD = 3V, -40×C TO 125×C) 0.8 0.7 Typical: Statistical Mean @25°C Maximum: Mean (Worst Case Temp) + 3σ (-40°C to 125°C) Max. 125°C 0.6 VOL (V) 0.5 Max. 85°C 0.4 Typical 25°C 0.3 0.2 Min. -40°C 0.1 0.0 5.0 5.5 6.0 6.5 7.0 7.5 8.0 8.5 9.0 9.5 10.0 IOL (mA) DS41202F-page 162 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 FIGURE 16-24: VOL vs. IOL OVER TEMPERATURE (VDD = 5.0V) 0.45 Typical: Statistical Mean @25°C Typical: Statistical @25×C+ 3σ Maximum: Mean (Worst Mean Case Temp) Maximum: Meas(-40×C + 3 to 125×C) (-40°C to 125°C) 0.40 Max. 125°C 0.35 Max. 85°C VOL (V) 0.30 0.25 Typ. 25°C 0.20 0.15 Min. -40°C 0.10 0.05 0.00 5.0 5.5 6.0 6.5 7.0 7.5 8.0 8.5 9.0 9.5 10.0 IOL (mA) FIGURE 16-25: VOH vs. IOH OVER TEMPERATURE (VDD = 3.0V) 3.5 3.0 Max. -40°C Typ. 25°C 2.5 Min. 125°C VOH (V) 2.0 1.5 1.0 Typical: Statistical Mean @25°C Maximum: Mean (Worst Case Temp) + 3σ (-40°C to 125°C) 0.5 0.0 0.0 -0.5 -1.0 -1.5 -2.0 -2.5 -3.0 -3.5 -4.0 IOH (mA) © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 163 PIC16F684 FIGURE 16-26: VOH vs. IOH OVER TEMPERATURE (VDD = 5.0V) (VDD = 5V, -40×C TO 125×C) 5.5 5.0 Max. -40°C Typ. 25°C VOH (V) 4.5 Min. 125°C 4.0 3.5 Typical: Statistical Mean @25°C Maximum: Mean (Worst Case Temp) + 3σ (-40°C to 125°C) 3.0 0.0 -0.5 -1.0 -1.5 -2.0 -2.5 -3.0 -3.5 -4.0 -4.5 -5.0 IOH (mA) FIGURE 16-27: TTL INPUT THRESHOLD VIN vs. VDD OVER TEMPERATURE (TTL Input, -40×C TO 125×C) 1.7 1.5 Typical: Statistical Mean @25°C Maximum: Mean (Worst Case Temp) + 3σ (-40°C to 125°C) Max. -40°C VIN (V) 1.3 Typ. 25°C 1.1 Min. 125°C 0.9 0.7 0.5 2.0 2.5 3.0 3.5 4.0 4.5 5.0 5.5 VDD (V) DS41202F-page 164 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 FIGURE 16-28: SCHMITT TRIGGER INPUT THRESHOLD VIN vs. VDD OVER TEMPERATURE (ST Input, -40×C TO 125×C) 4.0 VIH Max. 125°C 3.5 Typical: Statistical Mean @25°C Maximum: Mean (Worst Case Temp) + 3σ (-40°C to 125°C) VIH Min. -40°C VIN (V) 3.0 2.5 2.0 VIL Max. -40°C 1.5 VIL Min. 125°C 1.0 0.5 2.0 2.5 3.0 3.5 4.0 4.5 5.0 5.5 VDD (V) FIGURE 16-29: T1OSC IPD vs. VDD OVER TEMPERATURE (32 kHz) 45.0 40.0 Typical: Statistical Mean @25°C Maximum: Mean Mean (Worst Temp) + 3σ Maximum: (-40×C + 3 toCase 125×C) (-40°C to 125°C) 35.0 Max. 125°C IPD (mA) 30.0 25.0 20.0 15.0 Max. 85°C 10.0 5.0 Typ. 25°C 0.0 2.0 2.5 3.0 3.5 4.0 4.5 5.0 5.5 VDD (V) © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 165 PIC16F684 FIGURE 16-30: COMPARATOR RESPONSE TIME (RISING EDGE) 531 806 1000 900 Max. 125°C Response Time (nS) 800 700 600 Note: 500 VCM = VDD - 1.5V)/2 V+ input = VCM V- input = Transition from VCM + 100MV to VCM - 20MV Max. 85°C 400 300 Typ. 25°C 200 Min. -40°C 100 0 2.0 2.5 4.0 5.5 VDD (V) FIGURE 16-31: COMPARATOR RESPONSE TIME (FALLING EDGE) 1000 900 Max. 125°C 800 Response Time (nS) 700 600 Note: 500 VCM = VDD - 1.5V)/2 V+ input = VCM V- input = Transition from VCM - 100MV to VCM + 20MV Max. 85°C 400 300 Typ. 25°C 200 Min. -40°C 100 0 2.0 2.5 4.0 5.5 VDD (V) DS41202F-page 166 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 FIGURE 16-32: LFINTOSC FREQUENCY vs. VDD OVER TEMPERATURE (31 kHz) LFINTOSC 31Khz 45,000 40,000 Max. -40°C 35,000 Typ. 25°C Frequency (Hz) 30,000 25,000 20,000 Min. 85°C Min. 125°C 15,000 10,000 Typical: Statistical Mean @25°C Maximum: Mean (Worst Case Temp) + 3σ (-40°C to 125°C) 5,000 0 2.0 2.5 3.0 3.5 4.0 4.5 5.0 5.5 VDD (V) FIGURE 16-33: ADC CLOCK PERIOD vs. VDD OVER TEMPERATURE 8 Typical: Statistical Mean @25°C Maximum: Mean (Worst Case Temp) + 3σ (-40°C to 125°C) 125°C 6 Time (μs) 85°C 4 25°C -40°C 2 0 2.0 2.5 3.0 3.5 4.0 4.5 5.0 5.5 VDD (V) © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 167 PIC16F684 FIGURE 16-34: TYPICAL HFINTOSC START-UP TIMES vs. VDD OVER TEMPERATURE 16 Typical: Statistical Mean @25°C Maximum: Mean (Worst Case Temp) + 3σ (-40°C to 125°C) 14 85°C 12 25°C Time (μs) 10 -40°C 8 6 4 2 0 2.0 2.5 3.0 3.5 4.0 4.5 5.0 5.5 VDD (V) FIGURE 16-35: MAXIMUM HFINTOSC START-UP TIMES vs. VDD OVER TEMPERATURE -40C to +85C 25 Typical: Statistical Mean @25°C Maximum: Mean (Worst Case Temp) + 3σ (-40°C to 125°C) Time (μs) 20 15 85°C 25°C 10 -40°C 5 0 2.0 2.5 3.0 3.5 4.0 4.5 5.0 5.5 VDD (V) DS41202F-page 168 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 FIGURE 16-36: MINIMUM HFINTOSC START-UP TIMES vs. VDD OVER TEMPERATURE -40C to +85C 10 9 Typical: Statistical Mean @25°C Maximum: Mean (Worst Case Temp) + 3σ (-40°C to 125°C) 8 7 Time (μs) 85°C 6 25°C 5 -40°C 4 3 2 1 0 2.0 2.5 3.0 3.5 4.0 4.5 5.0 5.5 VDD (V) FIGURE 16-37: TYPICAL HFINTOSC FREQUENCY CHANGE vs. VDD (25°C) 5 4 Change from Calibration (%) 3 2 1 0 -1 -2 -3 -4 -5 2.0 2.5 3.0 3.5 4.0 4.5 5.0 5.5 VDD (V) © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 169 PIC16F684 FIGURE 16-38: TYPICAL HFINTOSC FREQUENCY CHANGE OVER DEVICE VDD (85°C) 5 4 Change from Calibration (%) 3 2 1 0 -1 -2 -3 -4 -5 2.0 2.5 3.0 3.5 4.0 4.5 5.0 5.5 VDD (V) FIGURE 16-39: TYPICAL HFINTOSC FREQUENCY CHANGE vs. VDD (125°C) 5 4 Change from Calibration (%) 3 2 1 0 -1 -2 -3 -4 -5 2.0 2.5 3.0 3.5 4.0 4.5 5.0 5.5 VDD (V) DS41202F-page 170 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 FIGURE 16-40: TYPICAL HFINTOSC FREQUENCY CHANGE vs. VDD (-40°C) 5 4 Change from Calibration (%) 3 2 1 0 -1 -2 -3 -4 -5 2.0 2.5 3.0 3.5 4.0 4.5 5.0 5.5 VDD (V) © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 171 PIC16F684 NOTES: DS41202F-page 172 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 17.0 PACKAGING INFORMATION 17.1 Package Marking Information 14-Lead PDIP Example XXXXXXXXXXXXXX XXXXXXXXXXXXXX YYWWNNN 14-Lead SOIC (.150”) XXXXXXXXXXX XXXXXXXXXXX YYWWNNN 14-Lead TSSOP XXXXXXXX YYWW NNN 16-Lead QFN Legend: XX...X Y YY WW NNN e3 * * Example PIC16F684-E e3 0510017 Example XXXX/ST 0510 017 Example XXXXXX XXXXXX YWWNNN Note: PIC16F684 -I/P e3 0510017 16F684-I /ML e3 510017 Customer-specific information Year code (last digit of calendar year) Year code (last 2 digits of calendar year) Week code (week of January 1 is week ‘01’) Alphanumeric traceability code Pb-free JEDEC designator for Matte Tin (Sn) This package is Pb-free. The Pb-free JEDEC designator ( e3 ) can be found on the outer packaging for this package. In the event the full Microchip part number cannot be marked on one line, it will be carried over to the next line, thus limiting the number of available characters for customer-specific information. Standard PIC device marking consists of Microchip part number, year code, week code, and traceability code. For PIC device marking beyond this, certain price adders apply. Please check with your Microchip Sales Office. For QTP devices, any special marking adders are included in QTP price. © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 173 PIC16F684 17.2 Package Details The following sections give the technical details of the packages. 14-Lead Plastic Dual In-Line (P or PD) – 300 mil Body [PDIP] Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at http://www.microchip.com/packaging N NOTE 1 E1 1 3 2 D E A2 A L A1 c b1 b e eB Units Dimension Limits Number of Pins INCHES MIN N NOM MAX 14 Pitch e Top to Seating Plane A – – .210 Molded Package Thickness A2 .115 .130 .195 Base to Seating Plane A1 .015 – – Shoulder to Shoulder Width E .290 .310 .325 Molded Package Width E1 .240 .250 .280 Overall Length D .735 .750 .775 Tip to Seating Plane L .115 .130 .150 Lead Thickness c .008 .010 .015 b1 .045 .060 .070 b .014 .018 .022 eB – – Upper Lead Width Lower Lead Width Overall Row Spacing § .100 BSC .430 Notes: 1. Pin 1 visual index feature may vary, but must be located with the hatched area. 2. § Significant Characteristic. 3. Dimensions D and E1 do not include mold flash or protrusions. Mold flash or protrusions shall not exceed .010" per side. 4. Dimensioning and tolerancing per ASME Y14.5M. BSC: Basic Dimension. Theoretically exact value shown without tolerances. Microchip Technology Drawing C04-005B DS41202F-page 174 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 14-Lead Plastic Small Outline (SL or OD) – Narrow, 3.90 mm Body [SOIC] Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at http://www.microchip.com/packaging D N E E1 NOTE 1 1 2 3 e h b A A2 c φ L A1 β L1 Units Dimension Limits Number of Pins α h MILLIMETERS MIN N NOM MAX 14 Pitch e Overall Height A – 1.27 BSC – Molded Package Thickness A2 1.25 – – Standoff § A1 0.10 – 0.25 Overall Width E Molded Package Width E1 3.90 BSC Overall Length D 8.65 BSC 1.75 6.00 BSC Chamfer (optional) h 0.25 – 0.50 Foot Length L 0.40 – 1.27 Footprint L1 1.04 REF Foot Angle φ 0° – 8° Lead Thickness c 0.17 – 0.25 Lead Width b 0.31 – 0.51 Mold Draft Angle Top α 5° – 15° Mold Draft Angle Bottom β 5° – 15° Notes: 1. Pin 1 visual index feature may vary, but must be located within the hatched area. 2. § Significant Characteristic. 3. Dimensions D and E1 do not include mold flash or protrusions. Mold flash or protrusions shall not exceed 0.15 mm per side. 4. Dimensioning and tolerancing per ASME Y14.5M. BSC: Basic Dimension. Theoretically exact value shown without tolerances. REF: Reference Dimension, usually without tolerance, for information purposes only. Microchip Technology Drawing C04-065B © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 175 PIC16F684 14-Lead Plastic Thin Shrink Small Outline (ST) – 4.4 mm Body [TSSOP] Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at http://www.microchip.com/packaging D N E E1 NOTE 1 1 2 e b A2 A c A1 φ Units Dimension Limits Number of Pins L L1 MILLIMETERS MIN N NOM MAX 14 Pitch e Overall Height A – 0.65 BSC – Molded Package Thickness A2 0.80 1.00 1.05 Standoff A1 0.05 – 0.15 1.20 Overall Width E Molded Package Width E1 4.30 6.40 BSC 4.40 Molded Package Length D 4.90 5.00 5.10 Foot Length L 0.45 0.60 0.75 Footprint L1 4.50 1.00 REF Foot Angle φ 0° – 8° Lead Thickness c 0.09 – 0.20 Lead Width b 0.19 – 0.30 Notes: 1. Pin 1 visual index feature may vary, but must be located within the hatched area. 2. Dimensions D and E1 do not include mold flash or protrusions. Mold flash or protrusions shall not exceed 0.15 mm per side. 3. Dimensioning and tolerancing per ASME Y14.5M. BSC: Basic Dimension. Theoretically exact value shown without tolerances. REF: Reference Dimension, usually without tolerance, for information purposes only. Microchip Technology Drawing C04-087B DS41202F-page 176 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 16-Lead Plastic Quad Flat, No Lead Package (ML) – 4x4x0.9 mm Body [QFN] Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at http://www.microchip.com/packaging D2 D EXPOSED PAD e E E2 2 2 1 b 1 TOP VIEW K N N NOTE 1 L BOTTOM VIEW A3 A A1 Units Dimension Limits Number of Pins MILLIMETERS MIN N NOM MAX 16 Pitch e Overall Height A 0.80 0.65 BSC 0.90 1.00 Standoff A1 0.00 0.02 0.05 Contact Thickness A3 0.20 REF Overall Width E Exposed Pad Width E2 Overall Length D Exposed Pad Length D2 2.50 2.65 2.80 b 0.25 0.30 0.35 Contact Length L 0.30 0.40 0.50 Contact-to-Exposed Pad K 0.20 – – Contact Width 4.00 BSC 2.50 2.65 2.80 4.00 BSC Notes: 1. Pin 1 visual index feature may vary, but must be located within the hatched area. 2. Package is saw singulated. 3. Dimensioning and tolerancing per ASME Y14.5M. BSC: Basic Dimension. Theoretically exact value shown without tolerances. REF: Reference Dimension, usually without tolerance, for information purposes only. Microchip Technology Drawing C04-127B © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 177 PIC16F684 NOTES: DS41202F-page 178 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 APPENDIX A: DATA SHEET REVISION HISTORY APPENDIX B: Revision A MIGRATING FROM OTHER PIC® DEVICES This is a new data sheet. This discusses some of the issues in migrating from other PIC devices to the PIC16F6XX Family of devices. Revision B B.1 Rewrites of the Oscillator and Special Features of the CPU Sections. General corrections to Figures and formatting. TABLE B-1: PIC16F676 to PIC16F684 Feature Revision C Max Operating Speed Revision D Max Program Memory (Words) Added Characterization Data. Updated Electrical Specifications. Incorporated Golden Chapter Sections for the following: • Section 3.0 “Oscillator Module (With Fail-Safe Clock Monitor)” • Section 5.0 “Timer0 Module” • Section 6.0 “Timer1 Module with Gate Control” • Section 7.0 “Timer2 Module” • Section 8.0 “Comparator Module” • Section 9.0 “Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) Module” • Section 11.0 “Enhanced Capture/Compare/PWM (With Auto-Shutdown and Dead Band) Module” Revision E Updated Package Drawings; Replace PICmicro with PIC. PIC16F676 PIC16F684 20 MHz 20 MHz 1024 2048 SRAM (bytes) 64 128 A/D Resolution 10-bit 10-bit Data EEPROM (Bytes) 128 256 Timers (8/16-bit) 1/1 2/1 Oscillator Modes 8 8 Brown-out Reset Y Y Internal Pull-ups RA0/1/2/4/5 RA0/1/2/4/5, MCLR Interrupt-on-change RA0/1/2/3/4/5 RA0/1/2/3/4/5 Comparator 1 2 ECCP N Y Ultra Low-Power Wake-Up N Y Extended WDT N Y Software Control Option of WDT/BOR N Y 4 MHz 32 kHz8 MHz N Y Revision F (03/2007) INTOSC Frequencies Replaced Package Drawings (Rev. AM); Replaced Development Support Section. Clock Switching Note: © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. FEATURE COMPARISON This device has been designed to perform to the parameters of its data sheet. It has been tested to an electrical specification designed to determine its conformance with these parameters. Due to process differences in the manufacture of this device, this device may have different performance characteristics than its earlier version. These differences may cause this device to perform differently in your application than the earlier version of this device. DS41202F-page 179 PIC16F684 NOTES: DS41202F-page 180 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 INDEX A A/D Specifications.................................................... 147, 148 Absolute Maximum Ratings .............................................. 129 AC Characteristics Industrial and Extended ............................................ 139 Load Conditions ........................................................ 138 ADC .................................................................................... 65 Acquisition Requirements ........................................... 72 Associated registers.................................................... 74 Block Diagram............................................................. 65 Calculating Acquisition Time....................................... 72 Channel Selection....................................................... 66 Configuration............................................................... 66 Configuring Interrupt ................................................... 68 Conversion Clock........................................................ 66 Conversion Procedure ................................................ 68 Internal Sampling Switch (RSS) Impedance................ 72 Interrupts..................................................................... 67 Operation .................................................................... 68 Operation During Sleep .............................................. 68 Port Configuration ....................................................... 66 Reference Voltage (VREF)........................................... 66 Result Formatting........................................................ 67 Source Impedance...................................................... 72 Special Event Trigger.................................................. 68 Starting an A/D Conversion ........................................ 67 ADCON0 Register............................................................... 70 ADCON1 Register............................................................... 70 ADRESH Register (ADFM = 0) ........................................... 71 ADRESH Register (ADFM = 1) ........................................... 71 ADRESL Register (ADFM = 0)............................................ 71 ADRESL Register (ADFM = 1)............................................ 71 Analog Input Connection Considerations............................ 57 Analog-to-Digital Converter. See ADC ANSEL Register .................................................................. 32 Assembler MPASM Assembler................................................... 126 B Block Diagrams (CCP) Capture Mode Operation ................................. 80 ADC ............................................................................ 65 ADC Transfer Function ............................................... 73 Analog Input Model ............................................... 57, 73 CCP PWM................................................................... 82 Clock Source............................................................... 19 Comparator 1 .............................................................. 56 Comparator 2 .............................................................. 56 Comparator Modes ..................................................... 58 Compare ..................................................................... 81 Crystal Operation ........................................................ 22 External RC Mode....................................................... 23 Fail-Safe Clock Monitor (FSCM) ................................. 29 In-Circuit Serial Programming Connections.............. 114 Interrupt Logic ........................................................... 107 MCLR Circuit............................................................. 100 On-Chip Reset Circuit ................................................. 99 PIC16F684.................................................................... 5 PWM (Enhanced)........................................................ 85 RA0 Pins ..................................................................... 35 RA1 Pins ..................................................................... 36 RA2 Pin....................................................................... 36 RA3 Pin....................................................................... 37 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. RA4 Pin ...................................................................... 37 RA5 Pin ...................................................................... 38 RC0 and RC1 Pins ..................................................... 41 RC2 and RC3 Pins ..................................................... 41 RC4 Pin ...................................................................... 42 RC5 Pin ...................................................................... 42 Resonator Operation .................................................. 22 Timer1 ........................................................................ 47 Timer2 ........................................................................ 53 TMR0/WDT Prescaler ................................................ 43 Watchdog Timer (WDT)............................................ 110 Brown-out Reset (BOR).................................................... 101 Associated ................................................................ 102 Calibration ................................................................ 101 Specifications ........................................................... 143 Timing and Characteristics ....................................... 142 C C Compilers MPLAB C18.............................................................. 126 MPLAB C30.............................................................. 126 Calibration Bits.................................................................... 99 Capture Module. See Enhanced Capture/ Compare/PWM (ECCP) Capture/Compare/PWM (CCP) Associated registers w/ Capture/Compare/PWM ....... 96 Capture Mode............................................................. 80 CCP1 Pin Configuration ............................................. 80 Compare Mode........................................................... 81 CCP1 Pin Configuration ..................................... 81 Software Interrupt Mode ............................... 80, 81 Special Event Trigger ......................................... 81 Timer1 Mode Selection................................. 80, 81 Prescaler .................................................................... 80 PWM Mode................................................................. 82 Duty Cycle .......................................................... 83 Effects of Reset .................................................. 84 Example PWM Frequencies and Resolutions, 20 MHZ .................................. 83 Example PWM Frequencies and Resolutions, 8 MHz .................................... 83 Operation in Sleep Mode.................................... 84 Setup for Operation ............................................ 84 System Clock Frequency Changes .................... 84 PWM Period ............................................................... 83 Setup for PWM Operation .......................................... 84 CCP1CON (Enhanced) Register ........................................ 79 Clock Sources External Modes........................................................... 21 EC ...................................................................... 21 HS ...................................................................... 22 LP ....................................................................... 22 OST .................................................................... 21 RC ...................................................................... 23 XT ....................................................................... 22 Internal Modes............................................................ 23 Frequency Selection........................................... 25 HFINTOSC ......................................................... 23 HFINTOSC/LFINTOSC Switch Timing ............... 25 INTOSC .............................................................. 23 INTOSCIO .......................................................... 23 LFINTOSC.......................................................... 25 Clock Switching .................................................................. 27 CMCON0 Register.............................................................. 61 DS41202F-page 181 PIC16F684 CMCON1 Register .............................................................. 62 Code Examples A/D Conversion ........................................................... 69 Assigning Prescaler to Timer0 .................................... 44 Assigning Prescaler to WDT ....................................... 44 Changing Between Capture Prescalers ...................... 80 Data EEPROM Read .................................................. 77 Data EEPROM Write .................................................. 77 Indirect Addressing ..................................................... 19 Initializing PORTA ....................................................... 31 Initializing PORTC....................................................... 40 Saving Status and W Registers in RAM ................... 109 Ultra Low-Power Wake-Up Initialization...................... 34 Write Verify ................................................................. 77 Code Protection ................................................................ 113 Comparator ......................................................................... 55 C2OUT as T1 Gate ..................................................... 62 Configurations ............................................................. 58 Interrupts ..................................................................... 59 Operation .................................................................... 59 Operation During Sleep .............................................. 60 Overview ..................................................................... 55 Response Time ........................................................... 59 Synchronizing COUT w/Timer1 .................................. 62 Comparator Module Associated Registers .................................................. 64 Comparator Voltage Reference (CVREF) Response Time ........................................................... 59 Comparator Voltage Reference (CVREF) ............................ 63 Effects of a Reset........................................................ 60 Specifications ............................................................ 146 Comparators C2OUT as T1 Gate ..................................................... 49 Effects of a Reset........................................................ 60 Specifications ............................................................ 146 Compare Module. See Enhanced Capture/ Compare/PWM (ECCP) CONFIG Register................................................................ 98 Configuration Bits................................................................ 97 CPU Features ..................................................................... 97 Customer Change Notification Service ............................. 187 Customer Notification Service........................................... 187 Customer Support ............................................................. 187 D Data EEPROM Memory Associated Registers .................................................. 78 Code Protection .................................................... 75, 78 Data Memory......................................................................... 7 DC and AC Characteristics Graphs and Tables ................................................... 151 DC Characteristics Extended and Industrial ............................................ 135 Industrial and Extended ............................................ 131 Development Support ....................................................... 125 Device Overview ................................................................... 5 E ECCP. See Enhanced Capture/Compare/PWM ECCPAS Register ............................................................... 93 EEADR Register ................................................................. 75 EECON1 Register ............................................................... 76 EECON2 Register ............................................................... 76 EEDAT Register.................................................................. 75 EEPROM Data Memory Avoiding Spurious Write.............................................. 78 DS41202F-page 182 Reading ...................................................................... 77 Write Verify ................................................................. 77 Writing ........................................................................ 77 Effects of Reset PWM mode ................................................................. 84 Electrical Specifications .................................................... 129 Enhanced Capture/Compare/PWM .................................... 79 Enhanced Capture/Compare/PWM (ECCP) Enhanced PWM Mode................................................ 85 Auto-Restart ....................................................... 94 Auto-shutdown.................................................... 93 Direction Change in Full-Bridge Output Mode.... 91 Full-Bridge Application........................................ 89 Full-Bridge Mode ................................................ 89 Half-Bridge Application ....................................... 88 Half-Bridge Application Examples ...................... 95 Half-Bridge Mode................................................ 88 Output Relationships (Active-High and Active-Low)................................................ 86 Output Relationships Diagram............................ 87 Programmable Dead-Band Delay....................... 95 Shoot-through Current ........................................ 95 Start-up Considerations ...................................... 92 Specifications ........................................................... 145 Timer Resources ........................................................ 79 Errata .................................................................................... 4 F Fail-Safe Clock Monitor ...................................................... 29 Fail-Safe Condition Clearing....................................... 29 Fail-Safe Detection ..................................................... 29 Fail-Safe Operation..................................................... 29 Reset or Wake-up from Sleep .................................... 29 Firmware Instructions ....................................................... 115 Fuses. See Configuration Bits G General Purpose Register File ............................................. 8 I ID Locations...................................................................... 113 In-Circuit Debugger........................................................... 114 In-Circuit Serial Programming (ICSP)............................... 114 Indirect Addressing, INDF and FSR registers..................... 19 Instruction Format............................................................. 115 Instruction Set................................................................... 115 ADDLW..................................................................... 117 ADDWF..................................................................... 117 ANDLW..................................................................... 117 ANDWF..................................................................... 117 BCF .......................................................................... 117 BSF........................................................................... 117 BTFSC ...................................................................... 117 BTFSS ...................................................................... 118 CALL......................................................................... 118 CLRF ........................................................................ 118 CLRW ....................................................................... 118 CLRWDT .................................................................. 118 COMF ....................................................................... 118 DECF ........................................................................ 118 DECFSZ ................................................................... 119 GOTO ....................................................................... 119 INCF ......................................................................... 119 INCFSZ..................................................................... 119 IORLW ...................................................................... 119 IORWF...................................................................... 119 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 MOVF........................................................................ 120 MOVLW .................................................................... 120 MOVWF .................................................................... 120 NOP .......................................................................... 120 RETFIE ..................................................................... 121 RETLW ..................................................................... 121 RETURN ................................................................... 121 RLF ........................................................................... 122 RRF........................................................................... 122 SLEEP ...................................................................... 122 SUBLW ..................................................................... 122 SUBWF ..................................................................... 123 SWAPF ..................................................................... 123 XORLW..................................................................... 123 XORWF..................................................................... 123 Summary Table......................................................... 116 INTCON Register ................................................................ 15 Internal Oscillator Block INTOSC Specifications............................................ 140, 141 Internal Sampling Switch (RSS) Impedance ........................ 72 Internet Address................................................................ 187 Interrupts ........................................................................... 106 ADC ............................................................................ 68 Associated Registers ................................................ 108 Comparator ................................................................. 59 Context Saving.......................................................... 109 Data EEPROM Memory Write .................................... 76 Interrupt-on-Change.................................................... 32 PORTA Interrupt-on-Change .................................... 107 RA2/INT .................................................................... 106 Timer0....................................................................... 107 TMR1 .......................................................................... 49 INTOSC Specifications ............................................. 140, 141 IOCA Register ..................................................................... 33 L Load Conditions ................................................................ 138 M MCLR ................................................................................ 100 Internal ...................................................................... 100 Memory Organization............................................................ 7 Data .............................................................................. 7 Data EEPROM Memory.............................................. 75 Program ........................................................................ 7 Microchip Internet Web Site .............................................. 187 Migrating from other PICmicro Devices ............................ 179 MPLAB ASM30 Assembler, Linker, Librarian ................... 126 MPLAB ICD 2 In-Circuit Debugger ................................... 127 MPLAB ICE 2000 High-Performance Universal In-Circuit Emulator .................................................... 127 MPLAB Integrated Development Environment Software .. 125 MPLAB PM3 Device Programmer .................................... 127 MPLAB REAL ICE In-Circuit Emulator System................. 127 MPLINK Object Linker/MPLIB Object Librarian ................ 126 O OPCODE Field Descriptions ............................................. 115 OPTION Register .......................................................... 14, 45 OSCCON Register .............................................................. 20 Oscillator Associated registers.............................................. 30, 51 Oscillator Module ................................................................ 19 EC ............................................................................... 19 HFINTOSC.................................................................. 19 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. HS............................................................................... 19 INTOSC ...................................................................... 19 INTOSCIO .................................................................. 19 LFINTOSC.................................................................. 19 LP ............................................................................... 19 RC .............................................................................. 19 RCIO........................................................................... 19 XT ............................................................................... 19 Oscillator Parameters ....................................................... 140 Oscillator Specifications.................................................... 139 Oscillator Start-up Timer (OST) Specifications ........................................................... 143 Oscillator Switching Fail-Safe Clock Monitor .............................................. 29 Two-Speed Clock Start-up ......................................... 27 OSCTUNE Register............................................................ 24 P P1A/P1B/P1C/P1D.See Enhanced Capture/ Compare/PWM (ECCP).............................................. 85 Packaging ......................................................................... 173 Marking..................................................................... 173 PDIP Details ............................................................. 174 PCL and PCLATH............................................................... 19 Stack........................................................................... 19 PCON Register ........................................................... 18, 102 PICSTART Plus Development Programmer..................... 128 PIE1 Register ..................................................................... 16 Pin Diagram PDIP, SOIC, TSSOP .................................................... 2 QFN .............................................................................. 3 Pinout Descriptions PIC16F684 ................................................................... 6 PIR1 Register ..................................................................... 17 PORTA ............................................................................... 31 Additional Pin Functions ............................................. 32 ANSEL Register ................................................. 32 Interrupt-on-Change ........................................... 32 Ultra Low-Power Wake-Up ........................... 32, 34 Weak Pull-up ...................................................... 32 Associated registers ................................................... 39 Pin Descriptions and Diagrams .................................. 35 RA0............................................................................. 35 RA1............................................................................. 35 RA2............................................................................. 36 RA3............................................................................. 37 RA4............................................................................. 37 RA5............................................................................. 38 Specifications ........................................................... 141 PORTA Register ................................................................. 31 PORTC ............................................................................... 40 Associated registers ................................................... 42 P1A/P1B/P1C/P1D.See Enhanced Capture/ Compare/PWM (ECCP)...................................... 40 Specifications ........................................................... 141 PORTC Register................................................................. 40 Power-Down Mode (Sleep)............................................... 112 Power-on Reset (POR)..................................................... 100 Power-up Timer (PWRT) .................................................. 100 Specifications ........................................................... 143 Precision Internal Oscillator Parameters .......................... 141 Prescaler Shared WDT/Timer0................................................... 44 Switching Prescaler Assignment ................................ 44 Program Memory .................................................................. 7 Map and Stack.............................................................. 7 DS41202F-page 183 PIC16F684 Programming, Device Instructions .................................... 115 PWM Mode. See Enhanced Capture/Compare/PWM ........ 85 PWM1CON Register ........................................................... 96 R Reader Response ............................................................. 188 Read-Modify-Write Operations.......................................... 115 Registers ADCON0 (ADC Control 0) .......................................... 70 ADCON1 (ADC Control 1) .......................................... 70 ADRESH (ADC Result High) with ADFM = 0)............. 71 ADRESH (ADC Result High) with ADFM = 1)............. 71 ADRESL (ADC Result Low) with ADFM = 0) .............. 71 ADRESL (ADC Result Low) with ADFM = 1) .............. 71 ANSEL (Analog Select)............................................... 32 CCP1CON (Enhanced CCP1 Control)........................ 79 CMCON0 (Comparator Control 0) .............................. 61 CMCON1 (Comparator Control 1) .............................. 62 CONFIG (Configuration Word).................................... 98 Data Memory Map ........................................................ 8 ECCPAS (Enhanced CCP Auto-shutdown Control) ... 93 EEADR (EEPROM Address) ...................................... 75 EECON1 (EEPROM Control 1)................................... 76 EECON2 (EEPROM Control 2)................................... 76 EEDAT (EEPROM Data) ............................................ 75 INTCON (Interrupt Control) ......................................... 15 IOCA (Interrupt-on-Change PORTA) .......................... 33 OPTION_REG (OPTION) ..................................... 14, 45 OSCCON (Oscillator Control) ..................................... 20 OSCTUNE (Oscillator Tuning) .................................... 24 PCON (Power Control Register) ................................. 18 PCON (Power Control) ............................................. 102 PIE1 (Peripheral Interrupt Enable 1) ........................... 16 PIR1 (Peripheral Interrupt Register 1) ........................ 17 PORTA........................................................................ 31 PORTC ....................................................................... 40 PWM1CON (Enhanced PWM Control) ....................... 96 Reset Values............................................................. 104 Reset Values (Special Registers) ............................. 105 Special Function Registers ........................................... 8 Special Register Summary ......................................... 11 STATUS ...................................................................... 13 T1CON ........................................................................ 50 T2CON ........................................................................ 54 TRISA (Tri-State PORTA) ........................................... 31 TRISC (Tri-State PORTC) .......................................... 40 VRCON (Voltage Reference Control) ......................... 63 WDTCON (Watchdog Timer Control)........................ 111 WPUA (Weak Pull-Up PORTA) .................................. 33 Reset................................................................................... 99 Revision History ................................................................ 179 S Shoot-through Current ........................................................ 95 Sleep Power-Down Mode ................................................... 112 Wake-up.................................................................... 112 Wake-up Using Interrupts ......................................... 112 Software Simulator (MPLAB SIM)..................................... 126 Special Event Trigger.......................................................... 68 Special Function Registers ................................................... 8 STATUS Register................................................................ 13 T T1CON Register.................................................................. 50 T2CON Register.................................................................. 54 DS41202F-page 184 Thermal Considerations.................................................... 137 Time-out Sequence .......................................................... 102 Timer0................................................................................. 43 Associated Registers .................................................. 45 External Clock............................................................. 44 Interrupt ...................................................................... 45 Operation .............................................................. 43, 47 Specifications ........................................................... 144 T0CKI ......................................................................... 44 Timer1................................................................................. 47 Associated registers ................................................... 51 Asynchronous Counter Mode ..................................... 48 Reading and Writing ........................................... 48 Interrupt ...................................................................... 49 Modes of Operation .................................................... 47 Operation During Sleep .............................................. 49 Oscillator..................................................................... 48 Prescaler .................................................................... 48 Specifications ........................................................... 144 Timer1 Gate Inverting Gate ..................................................... 49 Selecting Source .......................................... 49, 62 Synchronizing COUT w/Timer1 .......................... 62 TMR1H Register ......................................................... 47 TMR1L Register.......................................................... 47 Timer2 Associated registers ................................................... 54 Timers Timer1 T1CON ............................................................... 50 Timer2 T2CON ............................................................... 54 Timing Diagrams A/D Conversion......................................................... 149 A/D Conversion (Sleep Mode) .................................. 149 Brown-out Reset (BOR)............................................ 142 Brown-out Reset Situations ...................................... 101 CLKOUT and I/O ...................................................... 141 Clock Timing ............................................................. 139 Comparator Output ..................................................... 55 Enhanced Capture/Compare/PWM (ECCP)............. 145 Fail-Safe Clock Monitor (FSCM)................................. 30 Full-Bridge PWM Output............................................. 90 Half-Bridge PWM Output ...................................... 88, 95 INT Pin Interrupt ....................................................... 108 Internal Oscillator Switch Timing ................................ 26 PWM Auto-shutdown Auto-restart Enabled........................................... 94 Firmware Restart ................................................ 94 PWM Direction Change .............................................. 91 PWM Direction Change at Near 100% Duty Cycle..... 92 PWM Output (Active-High) ......................................... 86 PWM Output (Active-Low) .......................................... 87 Reset, WDT, OST and Power-up Timer ................... 142 Time-out Sequence Case 1 .............................................................. 103 Case 2 .............................................................. 103 Case 3 .............................................................. 103 Timer0 and Timer1 External Clock ........................... 144 Two Speed Start-up.................................................... 28 Wake-up from Interrupt............................................. 113 Timing Parameter Symbology .......................................... 138 TRISA Register................................................................... 31 TRISC Register................................................................... 40 Two-Speed Clock Start-up Mode........................................ 27 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 U Ultra Low-Power Wake-Up ....................................... 6, 32, 34 V Voltage Reference. See Comparator Voltage Reference (CVREF) Voltage References Associated Registers .................................................. 64 VREF. SEE ADC Reference Voltage W Wake-up Using Interrupts ................................................. 112 Watchdog Timer (WDT) .................................................... 110 Associated Registers ................................................ 111 Clock Source............................................................. 110 Modes ....................................................................... 110 Period........................................................................ 110 Specifications............................................................ 143 WDTCON Register ........................................................... 111 WPUA Register ................................................................... 33 WWW Address.................................................................. 187 WWW, On-Line Support ....................................................... 4 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 185 PIC16F684 NOTES: DS41202F-page 186 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 THE MICROCHIP WEB SITE CUSTOMER SUPPORT Microchip provides online support via our WWW site at www.microchip.com. This web site is used as a means to make files and information easily available to customers. Accessible by using your favorite Internet browser, the web site contains the following information: Users of Microchip products can receive assistance through several channels: • Product Support – Data sheets and errata, application notes and sample programs, design resources, user’s guides and hardware support documents, latest software releases and archived software • General Technical Support – Frequently Asked Questions (FAQ), technical support requests, online discussion groups, Microchip consultant program member listing • Business of Microchip – Product selector and ordering guides, latest Microchip press releases, listing of seminars and events, listings of Microchip sales offices, distributors and factory representatives • • • • • Distributor or Representative Local Sales Office Field Application Engineer (FAE) Technical Support Development Systems Information Line Customers should contact their distributor, representative or field application engineer (FAE) for support. Local sales offices are also available to help customers. A listing of sales offices and locations is included in the back of this document. Technical support is available through the web site at: http://support.microchip.com CUSTOMER CHANGE NOTIFICATION SERVICE Microchip’s customer notification service helps keep customers current on Microchip products. Subscribers will receive e-mail notification whenever there are changes, updates, revisions or errata related to a specified product family or development tool of interest. To register, access the Microchip web site at www.microchip.com, click on Customer Change Notification and follow the registration instructions. © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. DS41202F-page 187 PIC16F684 READER RESPONSE It is our intention to provide you with the best documentation possible to ensure successful use of your Microchip product. If you wish to provide your comments on organization, clarity, subject matter, and ways in which our documentation can better serve you, please FAX your comments to the Technical Publications Manager at (480) 792-4150. Please list the following information, and use this outline to provide us with your comments about this document. To: Technical Publications Manager RE: Reader Response Total Pages Sent ________ From: Name Company Address City / State / ZIP / Country Telephone: (_______) _________ - _________ FAX: (______) _________ - _________ Application (optional): Would you like a reply? Device: PIC16F684 Y N Literature Number: DS41202F Questions: 1. What are the best features of this document? 2. How does this document meet your hardware and software development needs? 3. Do you find the organization of this document easy to follow? If not, why? 4. What additions to the document do you think would enhance the structure and subject? 5. What deletions from the document could be made without affecting the overall usefulness? 6. Is there any incorrect or misleading information (what and where)? 7. How would you improve this document? DS41202F-page 188 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F684 PRODUCT IDENTIFICATION SYSTEM To order or obtain information, e.g., on pricing or delivery, refer to the factory or the listed sales office. PART NO. X /XX XXX Device Temperature Range Package Pattern Examples: a) b) Device: PIC16F684, PIC16F684T(1) VDD range 2.0V to 5.5V Temperature Range: I E Package: ML P SL ST Pattern: QTP, SQTPSM or ROM Code; Special Requirements (blank otherwise) = -40°C to +85°C = -40°C to +125°C = = = = PIC16F684-E/P 301 = Extended Temp., PDIP package, 20 MHz, QTP pattern #301 PIC16F684-I/SO = Industrial Temp., SOIC package, 20 MHz (Industrial) (Extended) Quad Flat No Leads (QFN) Plastic DIP 14-lead Small Outline (3.90 mm) Thin Shrink Small Outline (4.4 mm) Note 1: © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc. T = in tape and reel TSSOP, SOIC and QFN packages only. DS41202F-page 189 WORLDWIDE SALES AND SERVICE AMERICAS ASIA/PACIFIC ASIA/PACIFIC EUROPE Corporate Office 2355 West Chandler Blvd. Chandler, AZ 85224-6199 Tel: 480-792-7200 Fax: 480-792-7277 Technical Support: http://support.microchip.com Web Address: www.microchip.com Asia Pacific Office Suites 3707-14, 37th Floor Tower 6, The Gateway Habour City, Kowloon Hong Kong Tel: 852-2401-1200 Fax: 852-2401-3431 India - Bangalore Tel: 91-80-4182-8400 Fax: 91-80-4182-8422 India - New Delhi Tel: 91-11-4160-8631 Fax: 91-11-4160-8632 Austria - Wels Tel: 43-7242-2244-39 Fax: 43-7242-2244-393 Denmark - Copenhagen Tel: 45-4450-2828 Fax: 45-4485-2829 India - Pune Tel: 91-20-2566-1512 Fax: 91-20-2566-1513 France - Paris Tel: 33-1-69-53-63-20 Fax: 33-1-69-30-90-79 Japan - Yokohama Tel: 81-45-471- 6166 Fax: 81-45-471-6122 Germany - Munich Tel: 49-89-627-144-0 Fax: 49-89-627-144-44 Atlanta Duluth, GA Tel: 678-957-9614 Fax: 678-957-1455 Boston Westborough, MA Tel: 774-760-0087 Fax: 774-760-0088 Chicago Itasca, IL Tel: 630-285-0071 Fax: 630-285-0075 Dallas Addison, TX Tel: 972-818-7423 Fax: 972-818-2924 Detroit Farmington Hills, MI Tel: 248-538-2250 Fax: 248-538-2260 Kokomo Kokomo, IN Tel: 765-864-8360 Fax: 765-864-8387 Los Angeles Mission Viejo, CA Tel: 949-462-9523 Fax: 949-462-9608 Santa Clara Santa Clara, CA Tel: 408-961-6444 Fax: 408-961-6445 Toronto Mississauga, Ontario, Canada Tel: 905-673-0699 Fax: 905-673-6509 Australia - Sydney Tel: 61-2-9868-6733 Fax: 61-2-9868-6755 China - Beijing Tel: 86-10-8528-2100 Fax: 86-10-8528-2104 China - Chengdu Tel: 86-28-8665-5511 Fax: 86-28-8665-7889 Korea - Gumi Tel: 82-54-473-4301 Fax: 82-54-473-4302 China - Fuzhou Tel: 86-591-8750-3506 Fax: 86-591-8750-3521 Korea - Seoul Tel: 82-2-554-7200 Fax: 82-2-558-5932 or 82-2-558-5934 China - Hong Kong SAR Tel: 852-2401-1200 Fax: 852-2401-3431 Malaysia - Penang Tel: 60-4-646-8870 Fax: 60-4-646-5086 China - Qingdao Tel: 86-532-8502-7355 Fax: 86-532-8502-7205 Philippines - Manila Tel: 63-2-634-9065 Fax: 63-2-634-9069 China - Shanghai Tel: 86-21-5407-5533 Fax: 86-21-5407-5066 Singapore Tel: 65-6334-8870 Fax: 65-6334-8850 China - Shenyang Tel: 86-24-2334-2829 Fax: 86-24-2334-2393 Taiwan - Hsin Chu Tel: 886-3-572-9526 Fax: 886-3-572-6459 China - Shenzhen Tel: 86-755-8203-2660 Fax: 86-755-8203-1760 Taiwan - Kaohsiung Tel: 886-7-536-4818 Fax: 886-7-536-4803 China - Shunde Tel: 86-757-2839-5507 Fax: 86-757-2839-5571 Taiwan - Taipei Tel: 886-2-2500-6610 Fax: 886-2-2508-0102 China - Wuhan Tel: 86-27-5980-5300 Fax: 86-27-5980-5118 Thailand - Bangkok Tel: 66-2-694-1351 Fax: 66-2-694-1350 Italy - Milan Tel: 39-0331-742611 Fax: 39-0331-466781 Netherlands - Drunen Tel: 31-416-690399 Fax: 31-416-690340 Spain - Madrid Tel: 34-91-708-08-90 Fax: 34-91-708-08-91 UK - Wokingham Tel: 44-118-921-5869 Fax: 44-118-921-5820 China - Xian Tel: 86-29-8833-7250 Fax: 86-29-8833-7256 12/08/06 DS41202F-page 190 © 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.